blob: 5776820ab040e2a765ac90c1db958ee91bcfe50b [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000039static ExprResult
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000040CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn,
41 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation()) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000042 ExprResult E = S.Owned(new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc));
43 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
44 if (E.isInvalid())
45 return ExprError();
46 return move(E);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000047}
48
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000049static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
50 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +000051 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
52 bool CStyle);
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +000053
54static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
55 QualType &ToType,
56 bool InOverloadResolution,
57 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
58 bool CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000059static OverloadingResult
60IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
61 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
62 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
63 bool AllowExplicit);
64
65
66static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
67CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
68 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
69 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
70
71static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
72CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
73 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
74 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
75
76static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
77CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
78 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
79 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
80
81
82
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000083/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
84/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000086GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
87 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
88 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
89 ICC_Identity,
90 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
91 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
92 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000093 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000094 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
95 ICC_Promotion,
96 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +000097 ICC_Promotion,
98 ICC_Conversion,
99 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000100 ICC_Conversion,
101 ICC_Conversion,
102 ICC_Conversion,
103 ICC_Conversion,
104 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000105 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000106 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000107 ICC_Conversion,
108 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000109 ICC_Conversion
110 };
111 return Category[(int)Kind];
112}
113
114/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
115/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
116ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
117 static const ImplicitConversionRank
118 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
119 ICR_Exact_Match,
120 ICR_Exact_Match,
121 ICR_Exact_Match,
122 ICR_Exact_Match,
123 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000124 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000125 ICR_Promotion,
126 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000127 ICR_Promotion,
128 ICR_Conversion,
129 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000130 ICR_Conversion,
131 ICR_Conversion,
132 ICR_Conversion,
133 ICR_Conversion,
134 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000135 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000136 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000137 ICR_Conversion,
138 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000139 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
140 ICR_Conversion,
141 ICR_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000142 };
143 return Rank[(int)Kind];
144}
145
146/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
147/// implicit conversion.
148const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000149 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000150 "No conversion",
151 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
152 "Array-to-pointer",
153 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000154 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000155 "Qualification",
156 "Integral promotion",
157 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000158 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000159 "Integral conversion",
160 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000161 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000162 "Floating-integral conversion",
163 "Pointer conversion",
164 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000165 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000166 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000167 "Derived-to-base conversion",
168 "Vector conversion",
169 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000170 "Complex-real conversion",
171 "Block Pointer conversion",
172 "Transparent Union Conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000173 };
174 return Name[Kind];
175}
176
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000177/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
178/// sequence to the identity conversion.
179void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
180 First = ICK_Identity;
181 Second = ICK_Identity;
182 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000183 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000184 ReferenceBinding = false;
185 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000186 IsLvalueReference = true;
187 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
188 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000189 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000190 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000191}
192
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000193/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
194/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
195/// implicit conversions.
196ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
197 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
198 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
199 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
200 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
201 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
202 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
203 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
204 return Rank;
205}
206
207/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
208/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000209/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000210/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000211bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000212 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
213 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
214 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
215 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000216 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000217 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
218 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
219 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000220 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000221 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
222 return true;
223
224 return false;
225}
226
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000227/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
228/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
229/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
230/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000231bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000232StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000233isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000234 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000235 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000236
237 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
238 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
239 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
240 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
241 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
242
Douglas Gregor5d3d3fa2011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000243 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000244 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000245 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
246
247 return false;
248}
249
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000250/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
251/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
252void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000253 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000254 bool PrintedSomething = false;
255 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000256 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000257 PrintedSomething = true;
258 }
259
260 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
261 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000262 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000263 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000264 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000265
266 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000267 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000268 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000269 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000270 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000271 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000272 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000273 PrintedSomething = true;
274 }
275
276 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
277 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000278 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000279 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000280 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000281 PrintedSomething = true;
282 }
283
284 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000285 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000286 }
287}
288
289/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
290/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
291void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000292 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000293 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
294 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000295 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000296 }
Benjamin Kramerb11416d2010-04-17 09:33:03 +0000297 OS << '\'' << ConversionFunction << '\'';
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000298 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000299 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000300 After.DebugPrint();
301 }
302}
303
304/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
305/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
306void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000307 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000308 switch (ConversionKind) {
309 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000310 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000311 Standard.DebugPrint();
312 break;
313 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000314 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000315 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
316 break;
317 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000318 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000319 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000320 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000321 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000322 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000323 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000324 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000325 break;
326 }
327
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000328 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000329}
330
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000331void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
332 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
333}
334
335void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
336 conversions().~ConversionSet();
337}
338
339void
340AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
341 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
342 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
343 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
344}
345
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000346namespace {
347 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
348 // template parameter and template argument information.
349 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
350 TemplateParameter Param;
351 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
352 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
353 };
354}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000355
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000356/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
357/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
358OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000359static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
360 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000361 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000362 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
363 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
364 Result.Data = 0;
365 switch (TDK) {
366 case Sema::TDK_Success:
367 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000368 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
369 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000370 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000371
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000372 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000373 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000374 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
375 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000376
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000377 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000378 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000379 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
380 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000381 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
382 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
383 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
384 Result.Data = Saved;
385 break;
386 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000387
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000388 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000389 Result.Data = Info.take();
390 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000391
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000392 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000393 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000394 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000395 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000396
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000397 return Result;
398}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000399
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000400void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
401 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
402 case Sema::TDK_Success:
403 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
404 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000405 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
406 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000407 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000408 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000409
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000410 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000411 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000412 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000413 Data = 0;
414 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000415
416 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
417 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
418 Data = 0;
419 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000420
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000421 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000422 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000423 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
424 break;
425 }
426}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000427
428TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000429OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
430 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
431 case Sema::TDK_Success:
432 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000433 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
434 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000435 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000436 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000437
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000438 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000439 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000440 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000441
442 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000443 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000444 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000445
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000446 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000447 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000448 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
449 break;
450 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000451
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000452 return TemplateParameter();
453}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000454
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000455TemplateArgumentList *
456OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
457 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
458 case Sema::TDK_Success:
459 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
460 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
461 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
462 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
463 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
464 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000465 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000466 return 0;
467
468 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
469 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000470
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000471 // Unhandled
472 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
473 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
474 break;
475 }
476
477 return 0;
478}
479
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000480const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
481 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
482 case Sema::TDK_Success:
483 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
484 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000485 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
486 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000487 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000488 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000489 return 0;
490
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000491 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000492 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000493 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000494
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000495 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000496 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000497 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
498 break;
499 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000500
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000501 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000502}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000503
504const TemplateArgument *
505OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
506 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
507 case Sema::TDK_Success:
508 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
509 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000510 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
511 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000512 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000513 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000514 return 0;
515
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000516 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000517 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000518 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
519
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000520 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000521 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000522 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
523 break;
524 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000525
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000526 return 0;
527}
528
529void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000530 inherited::clear();
531 Functions.clear();
532}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000533
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000534// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000535// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
536// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
537// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
538// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000539// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
540// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
541// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000542//
543// Example: Given the following input:
544//
545// void f(int, float); // #1
546// void f(int, int); // #2
547// int f(int, int); // #3
548//
549// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000550// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000551//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000552// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
553// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
554// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
555// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000556//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000557// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
558// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
559// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
560// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000561// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
562// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000563//
564// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
565// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
566// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
567// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000568Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000569Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
570 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000571 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000572 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000573 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
574
575 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
576 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
577 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
578
579 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
580 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
581 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
582
583 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
584 }
585
586 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
587 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
588 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
589 // function templates hide function templates with different
590 // return types or template parameter lists.
591 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
592 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
593
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000594 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000595 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
596 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
597 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
598 continue;
599 }
600
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000601 Match = *I;
602 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000603 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000604 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000605 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
606 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
607 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
608 continue;
609 }
610
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000611 Match = *I;
612 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000613 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000614 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000615 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
616 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
617 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000618 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
619 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000620 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
621 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
622 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
623 // template instantiation.
624 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000625 // (C++ 13p1):
626 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
627 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000628 Match = *I;
629 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000630 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000631 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000632
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000633 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000634}
635
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000636bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
637 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall8246e352010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000638 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
639 // overloads.
640 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
641 return false;
642
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000643 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
644 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
645
646 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
647 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
648 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
649 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
650 return true;
651
652 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
653 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
654 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
655
656 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
657 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
658 // in the signature, they are overloads.
659
660 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
661 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
662 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
663 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
664 return false;
665
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +0000666 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
667 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000668
669 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
670 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
671 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
672 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
673 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
674 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000675 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000676 return true;
677
678 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
679 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
680 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
681 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
682 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
683 // signature.
684 //
685 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
686 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000687 //
688 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
689 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
690 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000691 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
692 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
693 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
694 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
695 return true;
696
697 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000698 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000699 //
700 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
701 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
702 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
703 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
704 // can be overloaded.
705 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
706 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
707 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
708 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000709 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000710 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
711 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
712 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
713 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
714 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
715 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000716 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
717 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
718 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
719 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000720 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
721 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
722 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
723 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
724 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000725
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000726 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000727 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000728
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000729 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
730 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000731}
732
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +0000733/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
734/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
735/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
736/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000737///
738/// void f(float f);
739/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
740///
741/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
742/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
743/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
744/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
745//
746/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
747/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
748/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
749/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
750/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000751///
752/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
753/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +0000754/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
755/// permitted.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000756static ImplicitConversionSequence
757TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
758 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000759 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000760 bool InOverloadResolution,
761 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000762 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000763 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000764 ICS.Standard, CStyle)) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000765 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000766 return ICS;
767 }
768
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000769 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000770 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000771 return ICS;
772 }
773
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000774 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
775 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
776 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
777 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
778 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
779 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
780 // called for those cases.
781 QualType FromType = From->getType();
782 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000783 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
784 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000785 ICS.setStandard();
786 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
787 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
788 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000789
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000790 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
791 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
792 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
793 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
794 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000795
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000796 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000797 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000798 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000799
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000800 return ICS;
801 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000802
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000803 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
804 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
805 // we can perform.
806 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000807 return ICS;
808 }
809
810 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000811 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
812 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000813 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000814 AllowExplicit);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000815
816 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000817 ICS.setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000818 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
819 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
820 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
821 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
822 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
823 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
824 // called for those cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000825 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000826 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000827 QualType FromCanon
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000828 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
829 QualType ToCanon
830 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +0000831 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000832 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000833 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
834 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000835 ICS.setStandard();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000836 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000837 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000838 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000839 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
Douglas Gregorbb2e68832009-02-02 22:11:10 +0000840 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000841 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
842 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000843 }
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +0000844
845 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
846 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
847 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
848 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
849 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
850 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
851 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000852 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000853 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000854 }
John McCalle8c8cd22010-01-13 22:30:33 +0000855 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000856 ICS.setAmbiguous();
857 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
858 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
859 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
860 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
861 if (Cand->Viable)
862 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000863 } else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000864 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000865 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000866
867 return ICS;
868}
869
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000870bool Sema::TryImplicitConversion(InitializationSequence &Sequence,
871 const InitializedEntity &Entity,
872 Expr *Initializer,
873 bool SuppressUserConversions,
874 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000875 bool InOverloadResolution,
876 bool CStyle) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000877 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
878 = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, Initializer, Entity.getType(),
879 SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000880 AllowExplicitConversions,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000881 InOverloadResolution,
882 CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000883 if (ICS.isBad()) return true;
884
885 // Perform the actual conversion.
886 Sequence.AddConversionSequenceStep(ICS, Entity.getType());
887 return false;
888}
889
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000890/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000891/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000892/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
893/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
894/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000895ExprResult
896Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000897 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
898 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
899 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
900}
901
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000902ExprResult
903Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000904 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
905 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000906 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
907 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
908 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000909 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
910 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000911 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
912}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000913
914/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000915/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000916static bool IsNoReturnConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000917 QualType ToType, QualType &ResultTy) {
918 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
919 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000920
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000921 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
922 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
923 // - a pointer
924 // - a member pointer
925 // - a block pointer
926 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
927 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
928 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
929 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
930 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
931 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
932 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
933 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
934 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
935 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
936 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
937 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
938 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
939 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
940 } else {
941 return false;
942 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000943
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000944 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
945 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
946 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
947 return false;
948 }
949
950 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
951 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
952 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
953
954 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
955 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
956 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
957
958 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000959 return true;
960}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000961
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000962/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
963/// vector conversion.
964///
965/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
966/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000967static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
968 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000969 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
970 // conversion.
971 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
972 return false;
973
974 // Identical types require no conversions.
975 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
976 return false;
977
978 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
979 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
980 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
981 // identity conversion.
982 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
983 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000984
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000985 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +0000986 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000987 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
988 return true;
989 }
990 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +0000991
992 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
993 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
994 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
995 // same size
996 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
997 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruth9c524c12010-08-08 05:02:51 +0000998 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
999 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001000 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1001 return true;
1002 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001003 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001004
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001005 return false;
1006}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001007
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001008/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1009/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1010/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1011/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1012/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1013/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1014/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1015/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001016static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1017 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001018 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1019 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001020 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001021
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001022 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001023 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001024 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001025 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001026 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001027 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001028
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001029 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001030 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001031 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001032 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001033 return false;
1034
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001035 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001036 }
1037
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001038 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1039 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1040 // (C++ 4p1).
1041
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001042 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001043 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1044 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001045 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001046 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001047 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1048 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1049 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001050
1051 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1052 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1053 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1054 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1055 QualType resultTy;
1056 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1057 if (!IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType,
1058 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1059 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1060 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1061 return false;
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001062 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001063
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001064 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1065 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1066 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1067 // expression.
1068 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1069 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1070 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1071 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1072 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1073 == UO_AddrOf &&
1074 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1075 const Type *ClassType
1076 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1077 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruth7750f762011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001078 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1079 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1080 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001081 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1082 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1083 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001084
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001085 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001086 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1087 FromType,
1088 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001089 } else {
1090 return false;
1091 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001092 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001093 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 4.1):
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001094 // An lvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can be
1095 // converted to an rvalue.
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001096 bool argIsLValue = From->isLValue();
1097 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001098 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001099 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001100 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001101
1102 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1103 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001104 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1105 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001106 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001107 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1108 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001109 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001110
1111 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1112 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1113 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001114 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001115
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001116 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001117 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001118 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001119
1120 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1121 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1122 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1123 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001124 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1125 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001126 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001127 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001128 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001129 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001130 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001131 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001132
1133 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1134 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1135 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001136 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001137 } else {
1138 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001139 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001140 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001141 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001142
1143 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1144 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1145 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1146 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001147 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1148 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001149 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001150 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001151 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001152 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1153 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001154 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001155 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001156 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001157 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001158 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001159 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001160 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001161 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001162 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001163 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001164 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001165 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1166 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001167 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1168 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1169 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1170 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1171 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1172 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1173 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1174 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1175 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001176 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001177 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001178 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001179 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001180 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001181 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001182 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001183 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1184 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001185 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1186 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001187 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1188 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1189 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001190 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001191 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1192 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1193 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001194 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001195 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001196 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001197 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001198 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001199 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001200 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001201 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1202 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001203 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1204 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001205 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001206 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001207 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001208 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001209 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001210 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001211 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001212 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001213 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001214 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1215 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001216 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1217 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001218 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001219 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001220 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001221 } else if (IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001222 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1223 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001224 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1225 InOverloadResolution,
1226 SCS, CStyle)) {
1227 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1228 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001229 } else {
1230 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001231 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001232 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001233 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001234
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001235 QualType CanonFrom;
1236 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001237 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001238 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001239 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001240 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001241 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1242 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001243 } else {
1244 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001245 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1246
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001247 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001248 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1249 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1250 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001251 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1252 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001253 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001254 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001255 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
1256 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001257 FromType = ToType;
1258 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1259 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001260 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001261 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001262
1263 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1264 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001265 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001266 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001267
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001268 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001269}
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001270
1271static bool
1272IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1273 QualType &ToType,
1274 bool InOverloadResolution,
1275 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1276 bool CStyle) {
1277
1278 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1279 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1280 return false;
1281 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1282 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1283 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1284 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1285 itend = UD->field_end();
1286 it != itend; ++it) {
1287 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, CStyle)) {
1288 ToType = it->getType();
1289 return true;
1290 }
1291 }
1292 return false;
1293}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001294
1295/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1296/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1297/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1298/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001299bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001300 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001301 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001302 if (!To) {
1303 return false;
1304 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001305
1306 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1307 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1308 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1309 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1310 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001311 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1312 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001313 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1314 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1315 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1316 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001317 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001318 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001319 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001320 }
1321
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001322 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1323 }
1324
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001325 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1326 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1327 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1328 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1329 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1330 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001331 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001332 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001333 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001334 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1335 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001336 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001337 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1338 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1339 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1340 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1341 return false;
1342
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001343 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001344 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregorc87f4d42010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001345 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001346 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1347 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001348 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001349
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001350 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001351 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1352 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1353 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001354 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001355 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001356 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001357 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001358 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001359 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001360 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001361 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1362 // unsigned.
1363 bool FromIsSigned;
1364 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001365
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001366 // FIXME: Is wchar_t signed or unsigned? We assume it's signed for now.
1367 FromIsSigned = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001368
1369 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1370 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001371 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1372 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001373 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1374 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001375 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001376 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001377 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1378 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001379 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001380 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1381 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1382 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1383 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001384 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001385 }
1386 }
1387 }
1388
1389 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1390 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1391 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1392 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1393 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1394 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1395 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001396 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1397 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001398 using llvm::APSInt;
1399 if (From)
1400 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001401 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001402 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001403 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1404 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1405 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001406
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001407 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1408 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1409 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1410 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1411 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001412
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001413 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1414 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1415 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1416 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1417 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001418
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001419 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001420 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001421 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001422
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001423 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1424 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001425 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001426 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001427 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001428
1429 return false;
1430}
1431
1432/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1433/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1434/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001435bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001436 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1437 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001438 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1439 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001440 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1441 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1442 return true;
1443
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001444 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1445 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1446 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1447 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1448 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1449 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1450 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1451 return true;
1452 }
1453
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001454 return false;
1455}
1456
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001457/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1458///
1459/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1460/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001461/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001462bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001463 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001464 if (!FromComplex)
1465 return false;
1466
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001467 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001468 if (!ToComplex)
1469 return false;
1470
1471 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001472 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1473 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1474 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001475}
1476
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001477/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1478/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1479/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1480/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1481/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001482static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001483BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001484 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
1485 ASTContext &Context) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001486 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1487 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1488 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001489
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001490 /// \brief Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1491 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
1492 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001493
1494 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001495 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001496 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001497 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001498
1499 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001500 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001501 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001502 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001503 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001504
1505 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1506 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001507 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1508 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001509 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1510 }
1511
1512 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001513 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1514 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001515
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001516 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1517 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1518 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001519}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001520
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001521static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001522 bool InOverloadResolution,
1523 ASTContext &Context) {
1524 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1525 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1526 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001527 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001528 return !InOverloadResolution;
1529
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001530 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1531 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1532 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001533}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001534
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001535/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1536/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1537/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1538/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1539/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1540/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001541///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001542/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1543/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1544/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1545/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1546/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1547/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001548/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1549/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1550/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001551bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001552 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001553 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001554 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001555 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001556 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1557 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001558 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001559
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001560 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1561 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001562 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001563 ConvertedType = ToType;
1564 return true;
1565 }
1566
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001567 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1568 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001569 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001570 ConvertedType = ToType;
1571 return true;
1572 }
1573 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1574 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001575 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001576 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001577 ConvertedType = ToType;
1578 return true;
1579 }
1580
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001581 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1582 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001583 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001584 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001585 ConvertedType = ToType;
1586 return true;
1587 }
1588
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001589 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001590 if (!ToTypePtr)
1591 return false;
1592
1593 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001594 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001595 ConvertedType = ToType;
1596 return true;
1597 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001598
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001599 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001600 // , including objective-c pointers.
1601 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
1602 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001603 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1604 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1605 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001606 ToType, Context);
1607 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001608 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001609 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001610 if (!FromTypePtr)
1611 return false;
1612
1613 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001614
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001615 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001616 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1617 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1618 return false;
1619
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001620 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1621 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1622 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001623 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1624 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001625 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001626 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001627 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001628 return true;
1629 }
1630
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001631 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1632 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001633 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001634 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001635 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001636 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001637 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001638 return true;
1639 }
1640
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001641 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001642 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001643 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1644 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1645 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1646 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1647 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1648 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1649 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1650 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1651 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001652 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1653 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001654 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1655 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001656 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001657 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001658 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001659 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001660 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001661 ToType, Context);
1662 return true;
1663 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001664
Fariborz Jahanianbc2ee932011-04-14 20:33:36 +00001665 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
1666 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1667 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1668 ToPointeeType,
1669 ToType, Context);
1670 return true;
1671 }
1672
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001673 return false;
1674}
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001675
1676/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
1677static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
1678 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
1679
1680 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
1681 if (TQs == Qs)
1682 return T;
1683
1684 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
1685 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
1686
1687 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
1688}
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001689
1690/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
1691/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
1692/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001693bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001694 QualType& ConvertedType,
1695 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1696 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1697 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001698
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001699 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
1700 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
1701
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001702 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001703 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
1704 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001705 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001706 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001707
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001708 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001709 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
1710 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
1711 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1712 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1713 return false;
1714
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001715 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001716 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001717 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001718 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001719 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001720 return true;
1721 }
1722 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001723 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001724 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001725 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00001726 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001727 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001728 return true;
1729 }
1730 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
1731 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
1732 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00001733 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1734 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1735 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
1736 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
1737 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1738 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001739 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001740 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1741 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001742 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001743 return true;
1744 }
1745
1746 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
1747 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
1748 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
1749 // complain about it.
1750 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001751 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001752 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1753 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001754 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001755 return true;
1756 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001757 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001758 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001759 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001760 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001761 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001762 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001763 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001764 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001765 // to a block pointer type.
1766 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001767 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001768 return true;
1769 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001770 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001771 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001772 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001773 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001774 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001775 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001776 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001777 return true;
1778 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001779 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001780 return false;
1781
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001782 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001783 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001784 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001785 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1786 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001787 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1788 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001789 return false;
1790
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001791 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
1792 // is an Objective-C conversion.
1793 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
1794 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1795 IncompatibleObjC)) {
1796 // We always complain about this conversion.
1797 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001798 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001799 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001800 return true;
1801 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001802 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
1803 // as in I* to id.
1804 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1805 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1806 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1807 IncompatibleObjC)) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001808 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001809 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001810 return true;
1811 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001812
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001813 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001814 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1815 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
1816 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001817 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001818 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001819 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001820 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001821 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
1822 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
1823 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
1824 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
1825 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
1826 return false;
1827
1828 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1829 // function types are obviously different.
1830 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1831 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
1832 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
1833 return false;
1834
1835 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
1836 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
1837 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
1838 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1839 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1840 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
1841 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1842 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1843 HasObjCConversion = true;
1844 } else {
1845 // Function types are too different. Abort.
1846 return false;
1847 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001848
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001849 // Check argument types.
1850 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1851 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1852 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1853 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1854 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
1855 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
1856 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1857 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
1858 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1859 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1860 HasObjCConversion = true;
1861 } else {
1862 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1863 return false;
1864 }
1865 }
1866
1867 if (HasObjCConversion) {
1868 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
1869 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001870 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001871 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1872 return true;
1873 }
1874 }
1875
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001876 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001877}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001878
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001879bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1880 QualType& ConvertedType) {
1881 QualType ToPointeeType;
1882 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
1883 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1884 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1885 else
1886 return false;
1887
1888 QualType FromPointeeType;
1889 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1890 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1891 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1892 else
1893 return false;
1894 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
1895 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1896 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
1897
1898 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
1899 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
1900 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
1901 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
1902
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001903 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
1904 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001905
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001906 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001907 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001908
1909 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1910 // function types are obviously different.
1911 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1912 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
1913 return false;
1914
1915 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
1916 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
1917 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
1918 return false;
1919
1920 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian12834e12011-02-13 20:11:42 +00001921 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1922 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001923 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1924 } else {
1925 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
1926 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
1927 if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
1928 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
1929 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
1930
1931 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
1932 // OK exact match.
1933 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
1934 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1935 if (IncompatibleObjC)
1936 return false;
1937 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1938 }
1939 else
1940 return false;
1941 }
1942
1943 // Check argument types.
1944 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1945 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1946 IncompatibleObjC = false;
1947 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1948 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1949 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
1950 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1951 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
1952 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1953 if (IncompatibleObjC)
1954 return false;
1955 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1956 } else
1957 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1958 return false;
1959 }
1960 ConvertedType = ToType;
1961 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001962}
1963
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001964/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
1965/// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
1966/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
1967/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001968bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00001969 const FunctionProtoType *NewType) {
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001970 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1971 return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(),
1972 NewType->arg_type_begin());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001973
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001974 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
1975 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
1976 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
1977 QualType ToType = (*O);
1978 QualType FromType = (*N);
1979 if (ToType != FromType) {
1980 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1981 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00001982 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
1983 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
1984 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
1985 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001986 continue;
1987 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001988 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
1989 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001990 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001991 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
1992 if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl())
1993 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001994 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001995 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001996 }
1997 }
1998 return true;
1999}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002000
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002001/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2002/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002003/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002004/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2005/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2006/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002007bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002008 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002009 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002010 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002011 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002012 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002013
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002014 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2015
Chandler Carruthffab8732011-04-09 07:32:05 +00002016 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
2017 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) &&
2018 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
2019 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
Chandler Carruth66a7b042011-04-09 07:48:17 +00002020 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2021 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00002022
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002023 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2024 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002025 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2026 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002027
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002028 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2029 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002030 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2031 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002032 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2033 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002034 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002035 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002036 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002037
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002038 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002039 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002040 }
2041 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002042 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002043 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002044 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002045 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002046 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2047 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2048 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002049 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002050 return false;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002051 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002052 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002053
2054 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2055 // reasons.
2056 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2057 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2058
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002059 return false;
2060}
2061
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002062/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2063/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2064/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2065/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2066/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2067bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002068 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002069 bool InOverloadResolution,
2070 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002071 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002072 if (!ToTypePtr)
2073 return false;
2074
2075 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002076 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2077 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2078 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002079 ConvertedType = ToType;
2080 return true;
2081 }
2082
2083 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002084 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002085 if (!FromTypePtr)
2086 return false;
2087
2088 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2089 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2090 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2091 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002092
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002093 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2094 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
2095 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002096 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2097 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2098 return true;
2099 }
2100
2101 return false;
2102}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002103
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002104/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2105/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002106/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002107/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2108/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2109/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002110bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002111 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002112 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002113 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002114 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002115 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002116 if (!FromPtrType) {
2117 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002118 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002119 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002120 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002121 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002122 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002123 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002124
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002125 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002126 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2127 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002128
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002129 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2130 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002131
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002132 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2133 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2134 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002135
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002136 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002137 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002138 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2139 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2140 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2141 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002142
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002143 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2144 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002145 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2146 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2147 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2148 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002149 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002150
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002151 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002152 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2153 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2154 << From->getSourceRange();
2155 return true;
2156 }
2157
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002158 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002159 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2160 Paths.front(),
2161 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002162
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002163 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002164 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002165 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002166 return false;
2167}
2168
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002169/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2170/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2171/// (C++ 4.4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002172bool
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002173Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00002174 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002175 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2176 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
2177
2178 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2179 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002180 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002181 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002182
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002183 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2184 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2185 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2186 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002187 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002188 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002189 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2190 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2191 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002192 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002193 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2194 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002195 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002196
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002197 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2198 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2199
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002200 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2201 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002202 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002203 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002204
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002205 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2206 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002207 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002208 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002209 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002210
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002211 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2212 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002213 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002214 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002215 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002216
2217 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2218 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2219 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2220 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2221 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002222 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002223}
2224
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002225/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2226/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2227/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2228/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2229/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2230/// false and User is unspecified.
2231///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002232/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2233/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2234/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002235static OverloadingResult
2236IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2237 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
2238 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
2239 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002240 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2241 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2242
2243 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2244 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002245 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002246 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2247 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2248 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2249 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2250 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2251 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2252 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2253 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002254 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002255 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002256 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002257 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2258
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7a6f2a32011-04-22 17:45:37 +00002259 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag());
2260 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
2261 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
2262 // to try to recover.
2263 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002264 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2265 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2266 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002267 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002268 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002269 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002270 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2271 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2272
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002273 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2274 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2275 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002276 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002277 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002278 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002279 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2280 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002281 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002282
Fariborz Jahanian11a8e952009-08-06 17:22:51 +00002283 if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
Anders Carlssond20e7952009-08-28 16:57:08 +00002284 Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002285 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002286 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2287 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002288 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002289 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2290 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002291 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002292 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2293 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002294 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2295 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2296 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2297 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002298 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002299 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002300 }
2301 }
2302
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002303 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
2304 if (ConstructorsOnly) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002305 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2306 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002307 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002308 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002309 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002310 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002311 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2312 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002313 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002314 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002315 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002316 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002317 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2318 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002319 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2320 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2321 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2322
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002323 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2324 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002325 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2326 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002327 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002328 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002329
2330 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2331 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002332 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2333 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2334 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002335 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002336 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2337 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002338 }
2339 }
2340 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002341 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002342
2343 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002344 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002345 case OR_Success:
2346 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2347 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2348 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002349 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
2350
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002351 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2352 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2353 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2354 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2355 // the argument of the constructor.
2356 //
2357 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2358 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2359 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2360 else {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002361 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00002362 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002363 }
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002364 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00002365 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002366 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2367 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2368 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2369 return OR_Success;
2370 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
2371 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002372 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion);
2373
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002374 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2375 //
2376 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2377 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2378 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2379 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2380 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2381 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00002382 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002383 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002384
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002385 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
2386 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2387 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2388 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2389 // is an initialization, the special rules for
2390 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2391 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2392 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2393 // 13.3.3.1).
2394 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2395 return OR_Success;
2396 } else {
2397 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002398 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002399 }
2400
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002401 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2402 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2403 case OR_Deleted:
2404 // No conversion here! We're done.
2405 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002406
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002407 case OR_Ambiguous:
2408 return OR_Ambiguous;
2409 }
2410
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002411 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002412}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002413
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002414bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002415Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002416 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00002417 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002418 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002419 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002420 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002421 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2422 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2423 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2424 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2425 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2426 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2427 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2428 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2429 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002430 return false;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002431 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002432 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002433}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002434
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002435/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2436/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2437/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002438static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2439CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2440 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2441 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002442{
2443 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2444 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2445 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2446 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
2447 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
2448 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
2449 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
2450 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002451 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002452 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
2453 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
2454 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
2455 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
2456 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002457 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
2458 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2459 else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
2460 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002461
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00002462 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
2463 // the same kind.
2464 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
2465 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2466
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002467 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
2468 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
2469 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002470 if (ICS1.isStandard())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002471 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002472 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002473 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
2474 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
2475 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
2476 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
2477 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
2478 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002479 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002480 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002481 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
2482 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002483 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
2484 }
2485
2486 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2487}
2488
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002489static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
2490 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
2491 Qualifiers Quals;
2492 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002493 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002494 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002495
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002496 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
2497}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002498
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002499// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
2500// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
2501static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2502compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
2503 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2504 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2505 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
2506 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2507
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002508 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00002509 // any non-identity conversion sequence
2510 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding == SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
2511 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2512 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2513 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2514 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2515 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002516
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002517 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
2518 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
2519 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2520 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
2521 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2522 else
2523 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002524 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002525 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2526
2527 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
2528 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
2529 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2530 }
2531
2532 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
2533 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2534 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2535 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2536
2537 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
2538 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2539 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2540 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002541
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002542 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2543}
2544
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002545/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
2546/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
2547static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
2548 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
2549 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2550 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
2551 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002552 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002553 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002554 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002555 // reference*.
2556 //
2557 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
2558 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
2559 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
2560 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
2561 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00002562 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
2563 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
2564 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002565
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002566 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
2567 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
2568 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
2569 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
2570}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002571
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002572/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
2573/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2574/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002575static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2576CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2577 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2578 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002579{
2580 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
2581 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2582
2583 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
2584 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
2585 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
2586 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
2587 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002588 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002589 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002590 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002591
2592 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
2593 // defined below), or, if not that,
2594 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
2595 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
2596 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
2597 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2598 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
2599 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002600
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002601 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
2602 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
2603 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002604
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002605 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
2606 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
2607 // that is such a conversion.
2608 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
2609 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
2610 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2611 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2612
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002613 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
2614 //
2615 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002616 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
2617 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
2618 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002619 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002620 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002621 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002622 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002623 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2624 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
2625 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002626 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2627 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002628 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2629 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
2630 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002631 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002632 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002633 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00002634 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
2635 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002636 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
2637 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
2638 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002639 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
2640 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002641
2642 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2643 // conversion, if we need to.
2644 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002645 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002646 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002647 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002648
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00002649 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2650 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002651
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002652 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002653 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002654 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002655 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2656
2657 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
2658 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00002659 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
2660 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2661 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
2662 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2663 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
2664 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
2665 FromObjCPtr2);
2666 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
2667 FromObjCPtr1);
2668 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
2669 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2670 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2671 }
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002672 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002673 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002674
2675 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
2676 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002677 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002678 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002679 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002680
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002681 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002682 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
2683 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
2684 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2685 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
2686 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002687
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002688 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2689 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
2690 // which the references refer are the same type except for
2691 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
2692 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
2693 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002694 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2695 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002696 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2697 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002698 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002699 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2700 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002701 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002702 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
2703 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002704 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002705 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002706 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002707 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002708 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
2709 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2710 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2711 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2712 }
2713 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002714
2715 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2716}
2717
2718/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2719/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002720/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
2721ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002722CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
2723 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2724 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00002725 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002726 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
2727 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
2728 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
2729 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
2730 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
2731 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
2732 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
2733 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2734
2735 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
2736 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002737 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2738 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002739 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2740 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002741 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002742 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2743 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002744
2745 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
2746 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002747 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002748 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2749
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002750 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2751 // for comparison.
2752 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002753 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002754 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002755 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002756
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002757 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002758 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002759 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002760 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2761 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2762 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002763 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002764 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
2765 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
2766 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
2767 // strict subset of qualifiers.
2768 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
2769 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
2770 // about how the sequences rank.
2771 ;
2772 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
2773 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2774 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
2775 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2776 // qualifiers.
2777 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002778
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002779 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2780 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
2781 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2782 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
2783 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2784 // qualifiers.
2785 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002786
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002787 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2788 } else {
2789 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
2790 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2791 }
2792
2793 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002794 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002795 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002796 }
2797
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002798 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
2799 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
2800 switch (Result) {
2801 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002802 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002803 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2804 break;
2805
2806 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
2807 break;
2808
2809 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002810 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002811 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2812 break;
2813 }
2814
2815 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002816}
2817
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002818/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2819/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002820/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
2821/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
2822/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002823ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002824CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
2825 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2826 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002827 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002828 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002829 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002830 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002831
2832 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2833 // conversion, if we need to.
2834 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002835 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002836 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002837 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002838
2839 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002840 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
2841 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
2842 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
2843 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002844
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002845 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002846 //
2847 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
2848 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002849 //
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002850 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002851 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00002852 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2853 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
2854 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
2855 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002856 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002857 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002858 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002859 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002860 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002861 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002862 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002863 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002864
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002865 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002866 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002867 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002868 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002869 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002870 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2871 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002872
2873 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
2874 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002875 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002876 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002877 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002878 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002879 }
2880 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2881 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
2882 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
2883 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2884 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
2885 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2886 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
2887 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2888 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
2889 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2890
2891 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
2892 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
2893 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
2894 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
2895 // Objective-C pointer types.
2896 bool FromAssignLeft
2897 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
2898 bool FromAssignRight
2899 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
2900 bool ToAssignLeft
2901 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
2902 bool ToAssignRight
2903 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
2904
2905 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
2906 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
2907 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
2908 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
2909 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2910 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
2911 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
2912 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2913
2914 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
2915 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
2916 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
2917 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2918 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
2919 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2920
2921 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
2922 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
2923 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
2924 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
2925 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2926 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
2927 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
2928 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2929
2930 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
2931 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
2932 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
2933 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2934 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
2935 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002936
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002937 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
2938 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2939 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
2940 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
2941 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2942 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2943
2944 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
2945 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
2946 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
2947 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2948 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002949 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002950 }
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002951
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002952 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002953 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
2954 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
2955 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002956 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002957 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002958 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002959 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002960 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002961 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002962 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002963 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2964 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
2965 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
2966 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
2967 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
2968 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2969 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2970 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2971 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002972 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002973 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002974 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002975 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002976 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002977 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2978 }
2979 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
2980 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002981 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002982 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002983 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002984 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2985 }
2986 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002987
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002988 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002989 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002990 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
2991 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2992 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002993 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2994 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
2995 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002996 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002997 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002998 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2999 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003000
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003001 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003002 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3003 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3004 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003005 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3006 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3007 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003008 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003009 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003010 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3011 }
3012 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003013
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003014 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3015}
3016
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003017/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3018/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3019/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3020/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3021/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3022/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3023/// type being initialized.
3024Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3025Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3026 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003027 bool &DerivedToBase,
3028 bool &ObjCConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003029 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3030 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3031 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3032
3033 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3034 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3035 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3036 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3037 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3038
3039 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3040 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3041 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3042 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003043 DerivedToBase = false;
3044 ObjCConversion = false;
3045 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3046 // Nothing to do.
3047 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003048 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3049 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003050 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3051 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3052 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3053 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003054 else
3055 return Ref_Incompatible;
3056
3057 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3058 // least).
3059
3060 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3061 // for comparison.
3062 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3063 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3064 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3065 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3066
3067 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3068 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3069 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3070 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3071 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3072 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3073 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
3074 if (T1Quals.getCVRQualifiers() == T2Quals.getCVRQualifiers())
3075 return Ref_Compatible;
3076 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
3077 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3078 else
3079 return Ref_Related;
3080}
3081
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003082/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003083/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3084static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003085FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3086 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3087 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3088 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003089 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3090 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3091 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3092
3093 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3094 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3095 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3096 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3097 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3098 NamedDecl *D = *I;
3099 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3100 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3101 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3102
3103 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3104 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3105 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3106 if (ConvTemplate)
3107 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3108 else
3109 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3110
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003111 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003112 // explicit conversions, skip it.
3113 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3114 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003115
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003116 if (AllowRvalues) {
3117 bool DerivedToBase = false;
3118 bool ObjCConversion = false;
3119 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003120 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
3121 DeclLoc,
3122 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3123 .getUnqualifiedType(),
3124 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
3125 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion) ==
3126 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003127 continue;
3128 } else {
3129 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
3130 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
3131 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
3132
3133 const ReferenceType *RefType =
3134 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3135 if (!RefType ||
3136 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
3137 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
3138 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003139 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003140
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003141 if (ConvTemplate)
3142 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003143 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003144 else
3145 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003146 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003147 }
3148
3149 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003150 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003151 case OR_Success:
3152 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3153 //
3154 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
3155 // applying a conversion function to the argument
3156 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
3157 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
3158 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
3159 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
3160 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
3161 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
3162 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
3163 return false;
3164
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003165 if (Best->Function)
3166 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003167 ICS.setUserDefined();
3168 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3169 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3170 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00003171 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003172 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
3173 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
3174 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
3175 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
3176 return true;
3177
3178 case OR_Ambiguous:
3179 ICS.setAmbiguous();
3180 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
3181 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
3182 if (Cand->Viable)
3183 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
3184 return true;
3185
3186 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3187 case OR_Deleted:
3188 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
3189 // conversion; continue with other checks.
3190 return false;
3191 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003192
Eric Christopheraba9fb22010-06-30 18:36:32 +00003193 return false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003194}
3195
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003196/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
3197/// initialization.
3198static ImplicitConversionSequence
3199TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType,
3200 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3201 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003202 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003203 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
3204
3205 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
3206 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3207 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3208
3209 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
3210 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
3211
3212 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
3213 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
3214 // type of the resulting function.
3215 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
3216 DeclAccessPair Found;
3217 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
3218 false, Found))
3219 T2 = Fn->getType();
3220 }
3221
3222 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
3223 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
3224 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003225 bool ObjCConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003226 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003227 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003228 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
3229 ObjCConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003230
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003231
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003232 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003233 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
3234 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
3235
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003236 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003237 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003238 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
3239 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
3240 //
3241 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
3242 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
3243 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003244 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003245 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
3246 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
3247 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
3248 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
3249 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
3250 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
3251 ICS.setStandard();
3252 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003253 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3254 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3255 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003256 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3257 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3258 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3259 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3260 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3261 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3262 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003263 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3264 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3265 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003266 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003267 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003268
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003269 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
3270 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
3271 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
3272 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003273 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003274 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003275
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003276 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
3277 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
3278 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
3279 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
3280 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
3281 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
3282 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
3283 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003284 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003285 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003286 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3287 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
3288 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003289 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003290 }
3291 }
3292
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003293 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
3294 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003295 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003296 //
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003297 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
3298 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
3299 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
3300 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
3301 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
3302 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
3303 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003304 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
3305 // go together.
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003306 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified())
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003307 return ICS;
3308
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003309 // -- If the initializer expression
3310 //
3311 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
3312 // lvalue and "cv1T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
3313 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
3314 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
3315 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
3316 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
3317 ICS.setStandard();
3318 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003319 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003320 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3321 : ICK_Identity;
3322 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3323 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3324 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3325 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3326 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3327 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3328 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
3329 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
3330 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
3331 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
3332 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003333 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
3334 S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x ||
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003335 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003336 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3337 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003338 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003339 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003340 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003341 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003342 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003343
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003344 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
3345 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003346 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
3347 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003348 // "cv3 T3",
3349 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003350 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003351 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003352 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003353 // class subobject).
3354 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003355 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003356 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3357 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
3358 AllowExplicit)) {
3359 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
3360 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
3361 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
3362 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003363 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003364 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
3365 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3366
Douglas Gregor95273c32011-01-21 16:36:05 +00003367 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolabe468d92011-01-22 15:32:35 +00003368 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003369
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003370 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
3371 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
3372 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
3373 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
3374 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
3375 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
3376 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
3377 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
3378 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
3379 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
3380 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
3381 // initialization fails.
3382 return ICS;
3383 }
3384
3385 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
3386 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
3387 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
3388 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
3389 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
3390 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3391 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
3392 return ICS;
3393
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003394 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
3395 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
3396 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
3397 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
3398 return ICS;
3399
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003400 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003401 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
3402 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
3403 // required to convert the argument expression to the
3404 // underlying type of the reference according to
3405 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
3406 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
3407 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
3408 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
3409 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003410 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
3411 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003412 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3413 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003414
3415 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
3416 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
3417 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003418 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3419 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3420 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003421 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003422 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
3423 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003424 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3425 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3426 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003427 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003428 }
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003429
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003430 return ICS;
3431}
3432
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003433/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
3434/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
3435/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
3436/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003437/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00003438/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003439static ImplicitConversionSequence
3440TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003441 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003442 bool InOverloadResolution) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003443 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003444 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003445 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
3446 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003447 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003448
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003449 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
3450 SuppressUserConversions,
3451 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003452 InOverloadResolution,
3453 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003454}
3455
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003456/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
3457/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
3458/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003459static ImplicitConversionSequence
3460TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003461 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003462 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
3463 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
3464 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00003465 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
3466 // const volatile object.
3467 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
3468 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003469 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003470
3471 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
3472 // to exit early.
3473 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003474
3475 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00003476 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003477 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003478 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
3479
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003480 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
3481 // better have an lvalue.
3482 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
3483 }
3484
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003485 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003486
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003487 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003488 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003489 // parameter is
3490 //
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00003491 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
3492 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
3493 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003494 // ref-qualifier
3495 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003496 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003497 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
3498 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003499 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003500 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003501 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
3502 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
3503 // non-constant references.
3504
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003505 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003506 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003507 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003508 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003509 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003510 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
3511 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003512 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003513 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003514
3515 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
3516 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003517 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003518 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
3519 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
3520 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003521 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003522 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003523 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003524 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
3525 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003526 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003527 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003528
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003529 // Check the ref-qualifier.
3530 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
3531 case RQ_None:
3532 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
3533 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003534
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003535 case RQ_LValue:
3536 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
3537 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003538 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003539 ImplicitParamType);
3540 return ICS;
3541 }
3542 break;
3543
3544 case RQ_RValue:
3545 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
3546 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003547 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003548 ImplicitParamType);
3549 return ICS;
3550 }
3551 break;
3552 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003553
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003554 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003555 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003556 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3557 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003558 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003559 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003560 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3561 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003562 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003563 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003564 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
3565 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
3566 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003567 return ICS;
3568}
3569
3570/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
3571/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
3572/// expression.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003573ExprResult
3574Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003575 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003576 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003577 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003578 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003579 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003580 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003581
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003582 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003583 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003584 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
3585 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003586 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003587 } else {
3588 FromRecordType = From->getType();
3589 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003590 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003591 }
3592
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003593 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
3594 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003595 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003596 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
3597 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003598 if (ICS.isBad()) {
3599 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
3600 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
3601 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
3602 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
3603 if (CVR) {
3604 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3605 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
3606 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
3607 << From->getSourceRange();
3608 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3609 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003610 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003611 }
3612 }
3613
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003614 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003615 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003616 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003617 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003618
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003619 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
3620 ExprResult FromRes =
3621 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
3622 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
3623 return ExprError();
3624 From = FromRes.take();
3625 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003626
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003627 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003628 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
3629 From->getType()->isPointerType() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue).take();
3630 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003631}
3632
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003633/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
3634/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003635static ImplicitConversionSequence
3636TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00003637 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003638 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00003639 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3640 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003641 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003642 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3643 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003644}
3645
3646/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
3647/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003648ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003649 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003650 if (!ICS.isBad())
3651 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003652
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003653 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00003654 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3655 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003656 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003657 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003658}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003659
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003660/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Attempt to contextually convert the
3661/// expression From to 'id'.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003662static ImplicitConversionSequence
3663TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
3664 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
3665 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
3666 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3667 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
3668 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003669 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3670 /*CStyle=*/false);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003671}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003672
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003673/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Perform a contextual conversion
3674/// of the expression From to 'id'.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003675ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Expr *From) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003676 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003677 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003678 if (!ICS.isBad())
3679 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003680 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003681}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003682
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003683/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003684/// enumeration type.
3685///
3686/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
3687/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
3688/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3689///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003690/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
3691/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003692///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003693/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
3694///
3695/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
3696/// have integral or enumeration type.
3697///
3698/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
3699/// incomplete class type.
3700///
3701/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
3702/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
3703/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
3704///
3705/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
3706/// showing which conversion was picked.
3707///
3708/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
3709/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
3710///
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003711/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003712/// usable conversion function.
3713///
3714/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
3715/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
3716///
3717/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
3718/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003719ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003720Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003721 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
3722 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
3723 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
3724 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
3725 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003726 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
3727 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003728 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
3729 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003730 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003731
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003732 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
3733 QualType T = From->getType();
3734 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003735 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003736
3737 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
3738
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003739 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003740 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
3741 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
3742 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
3743 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3744 << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003745 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003746 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003747
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003748 // We must have a complete class type.
3749 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003750 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003751
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003752 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3753 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
3754 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
3755 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3756 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003757
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003758 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003759 E = Conversions->end();
3760 I != E;
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003761 ++I) {
3762 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3763 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
3764 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3765 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
3766 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
3767 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3768 else
3769 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3770 }
3771 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003772
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003773 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
3774 case 0:
3775 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
3776 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
3777 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3778 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003779
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003780 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
3781 // conversion; use it.
3782 QualType ConvTy
3783 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3784 std::string TypeStr;
3785 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, Context.PrintingPolicy);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003786
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003787 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
3788 << T << ConvTy
3789 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
3790 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
3791 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
3792 ")");
3793 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
3794 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003795
3796 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003797 // explicit conversion function.
3798 if (isSFINAEContext())
3799 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003800
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003801 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003802 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion);
3803 if (Result.isInvalid())
3804 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003805
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003806 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003807 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003808
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003809 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
3810 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003811
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003812 case 1: {
3813 // Apply this conversion.
3814 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
3815 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003816
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003817 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3818 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
3819 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003820 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003821 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
3822 if (isSFINAEContext())
3823 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003824
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003825 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
3826 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
3827 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003828
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003829 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003830 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003831 if (Result.isInvalid())
3832 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003833
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003834 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003835 break;
3836 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003837
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003838 default:
3839 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
3840 << T << From->getSourceRange();
3841 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
3842 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
3843 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
3844 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3845 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
3846 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
3847 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003848 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003849 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003850
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00003851 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003852 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3853 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003854
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003855 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003856}
3857
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003858/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003859/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
3860/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
3861/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003862///
3863/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
3864/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
3865/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003866void
3867Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003868 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003869 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003870 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00003871 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003872 bool PartialOverloading) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003873 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003874 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003875 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003876 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00003877 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003878
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003879 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003880 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
3881 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
3882 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
3883 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
3884 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003885 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
3886 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
3887 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003888 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003889 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003890 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003891 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003892 return;
3893 }
3894 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
3895 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003896 }
3897
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00003898 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003899 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003900
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003901 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00003902 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003903
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003904 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
3905 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
3906 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
3907 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
3908 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003909 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00003910 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00003911 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
3912 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003913 return;
3914 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003915
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003916 // Add this candidate
3917 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3918 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003919 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003920 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003921 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003922 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003923 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00003924 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003925
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003926 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3927
3928 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3929 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3930 // list (8.3.5).
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003931 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00003932 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003933 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003934 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003935 return;
3936 }
3937
3938 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
3939 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
3940 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
3941 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
3942 // exactly m parameters.
3943 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003944 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003945 // Not enough arguments.
3946 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003947 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003948 return;
3949 }
3950
3951 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3952 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003953 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
3954 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3955 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3956 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3957 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3958 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3959 // parameter of F.
3960 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003961 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003962 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003963 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003964 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003965 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
3966 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003967 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003968 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003969 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003970 } else {
3971 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3972 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3973 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003974 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003975 }
3976 }
3977}
3978
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003979/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
3980/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003981void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003982 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3983 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
3984 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003985 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003986 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
3987 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003988 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003989 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003990 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003991 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003992 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003993 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3994 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003995 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003996 SuppressUserConversions);
3997 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003998 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003999 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4000 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004001 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004002 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004003 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004004 Args[0]->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004005 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
4006 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004007 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00004008 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004009 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004010 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004011 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004012 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
4013 SuppressUserConversions);
4014 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00004015 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004016}
4017
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004018/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
4019/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004020void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004021 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004022 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004023 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4024 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004025 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004026 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004027 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004028
4029 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
4030 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004031
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004032 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
4033 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4034 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004035 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
4036 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004037 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004038 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004039 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004040 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004041 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004042 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004043 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004044 }
4045}
4046
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004047/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
4048/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
4049/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
4050/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
4051/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
4052/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004053/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004054void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004055Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004056 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004057 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004058 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004059 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004060 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004061 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004062 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004063 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004064 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
4065 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004066
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004067 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
4068 return;
4069
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004070 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004071 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004072
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004073 // Add this candidate
4074 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4075 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004076 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004077 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004078 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004079 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004080 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004081
4082 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4083
4084 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4085 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4086 // list (8.3.5).
4087 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4088 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004089 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004090 return;
4091 }
4092
4093 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
4094 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
4095 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
4096 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
4097 // exactly m parameters.
4098 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
4099 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
4100 // Not enough arguments.
4101 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004102 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004103 return;
4104 }
4105
4106 Candidate.Viable = true;
4107 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
4108
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004109 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004110 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
4111 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
4112 else {
4113 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
4114 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004115 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004116 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4117 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004118 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004119 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004120 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004121 return;
4122 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004123 }
4124
4125 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4126 // arguments.
4127 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4128 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4129 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4130 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4131 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4132 // parameter of F.
4133 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004134 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004135 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004136 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00004137 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004138 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004139 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004140 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004141 break;
4142 }
4143 } else {
4144 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4145 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4146 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004147 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004148 }
4149 }
4150}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004151
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004152/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
4153/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
4154/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004155void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004156Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004157 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004158 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004159 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004160 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004161 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004162 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004163 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004164 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004165 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
4166 return;
4167
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004168 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004169 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004170 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004171 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004172 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4173 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4174 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4175 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4176 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004177 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004178 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4179 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004180 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004181 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004182 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4183 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4184 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4185 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
4186 Candidate.Viable = false;
4187 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4188 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4189 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004190 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004191 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004192 Info);
4193 return;
4194 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004195
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004196 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4197 // deduction as a candidate.
4198 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004199 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004200 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004201 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004202 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4203 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004204}
4205
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004206/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
4207/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
4208/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004209void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004210Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004211 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004212 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004213 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4214 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004215 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004216 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4217 return;
4218
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004219 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004220 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004221 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004222 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004223 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4224 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4225 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4226 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4227 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004228 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004229 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4230 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004231 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00004232 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004233 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4234 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004235 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004236 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4237 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004238 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004239 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4240 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004241 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004242 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004243 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004244 return;
4245 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004246
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004247 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4248 // deduction as a candidate.
4249 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004250 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004251 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004252}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004253
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004254/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004255/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004256/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004257/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004258/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
4259/// conversion function produces).
4260void
4261Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004262 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004263 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004264 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4265 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004266 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
4267 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004268 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004269 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4270 return;
4271
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004272 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004273 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004274
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004275 // Add this candidate
4276 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4277 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004278 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004279 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004280 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004281 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004282 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004283 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004284 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004285 Candidate.Viable = true;
4286 Candidate.Conversions.resize(1);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004287 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004288
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004289 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004290 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
4291 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004292 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004293 //
4294 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4295 // object parameter.
4296 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
4297 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
4298 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
4299 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
4300 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004301
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004302 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004303 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
4304 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004305 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004306
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004307 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004308 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004309 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004310 return;
4311 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004312
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004313 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004314 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
4315 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
4316 QualType FromCanon
4317 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
4318 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
4319 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
4320 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004321 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004322 return;
4323 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004324
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004325 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
4326 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
4327 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
4328 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
4329 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
4330 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
4331 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
4332 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004333 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004334 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004335 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
4336 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004337 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00004338 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004339
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00004340 QualType CallResultType
4341 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
4342 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), CallResultType, 0)) {
4343 Candidate.Viable = false;
4344 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4345 return;
4346 }
4347
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004348 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(Conversion->getConversionType());
4349
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004350 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00004351 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
4352 // allocator).
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004353 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00004354 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004355 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004356 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004357 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004358 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004359
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004360 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004361 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4362 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004363
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004364 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
4365 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004366 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004367 // shall have exact match rank.
4368 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
4369 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
4370 Candidate.Viable = false;
4371 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
4372 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004373
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004374 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4375 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
4376 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
4377 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
4378 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004379 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004380 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
4381 Candidate.Viable = false;
4382 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4383 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004384 break;
4385
4386 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4387 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004388 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004389 break;
4390
4391 default:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004392 assert(false &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004393 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
4394 }
4395}
4396
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004397/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
4398/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
4399/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
4400/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
4401/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004402void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004403Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004404 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004405 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004406 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4407 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4408 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4409 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
4410
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004411 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4412 return;
4413
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004414 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004415 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4416 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004417 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004418 Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004419 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4420 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4421 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4422 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4423 Candidate.Viable = false;
4424 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4425 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4426 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004427 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004428 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004429 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004430 return;
4431 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004432
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004433 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
4434 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
4435 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004436 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004437 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004438}
4439
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004440/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
4441/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
4442/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
4443/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
4444/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
4445void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004446 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004447 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004448 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004449 Expr *Object,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004450 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004451 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004452 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4453 return;
4454
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004455 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004456 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004457
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004458 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4459 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004460 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004461 Candidate.Function = 0;
4462 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
4463 Candidate.Viable = true;
4464 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004465 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004466 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004467 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004468
4469 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4470 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004471 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004472 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004473 Object->Classify(Context),
4474 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004475 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004476 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004477 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004478 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004479 return;
4480 }
4481
4482 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
4483 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
4484 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004485 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004486 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00004487 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004488 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004489 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00004490 = FoundDecl.getDecl();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004491 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004492 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
4493 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4494
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004495 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004496 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4497
4498 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4499 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4500 // list (8.3.5).
4501 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4502 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004503 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004504 return;
4505 }
4506
4507 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
4508 // we have enough arguments.
4509 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
4510 // Not enough arguments.
4511 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004512 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004513 return;
4514 }
4515
4516 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4517 // arguments.
4518 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4519 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4520 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4521 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4522 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4523 // parameter of F.
4524 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004525 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004526 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004527 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004528 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004529 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004530 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004531 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004532 break;
4533 }
4534 } else {
4535 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4536 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4537 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004538 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004539 }
4540 }
4541}
4542
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004543/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
4544/// member functions.
4545///
4546/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
4547/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
4548/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
4549/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
4550/// [over.match.oper]).
4551void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
4552 SourceLocation OpLoc,
4553 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4554 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4555 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004556 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
4557
4558 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
4559 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
4560 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
4561 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
4562 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
4563 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
4564 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
4565 // constructed as follows:
4566 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004567
4568 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
4569 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
4570 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
4571 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004572 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004573 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004574 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004575 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004576
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00004577 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
4578 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
4579 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
4580
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004581 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004582 OperEnd = Operators.end();
4583 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004584 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004585 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004586 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004587 CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004588 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004589 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004590}
4591
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004592/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
4593/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
4594/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004595/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
4596/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004597/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
4598/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
4599/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004600void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004601 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004602 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004603 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
4604 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004605 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004606 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004607
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004608 // Add this candidate
4609 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4610 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004611 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004612 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00004613 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004614 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004615 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
4616 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
4617 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
4618
4619 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4620 // arguments.
4621 Candidate.Viable = true;
4622 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004623 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004624 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004625 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
4626 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
4627 // left operand are restricted as follows:
4628 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
4629 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
4630 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004631 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004632 //
4633 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
4634 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
4635 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
4636 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004637 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004638 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004639 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004640 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
4641 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004642 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004643 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004644 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004645 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004646 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004647 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004648 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004649 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004650 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004651 break;
4652 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004653 }
4654}
4655
4656/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
4657/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
4658/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
4659/// enumeration types.
4660class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
4661 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004662 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004663
4664 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
4665 /// built-in candidates.
4666 TypeSet PointerTypes;
4667
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004668 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
4669 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4670 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
4671
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004672 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
4673 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4674 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
4675
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004676 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004677 /// candidates.
4678 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004679
4680 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
4681 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
4682
4683 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
4684 /// were present in the candidate set.
4685 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
4686
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004687 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
4688 /// candidate type set.
4689 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004690
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004691 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
4692 ASTContext &Context;
4693
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004694 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4695 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004696 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004697
4698public:
4699 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004700 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004701
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004702 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004703 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
4704 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
4705 SemaRef(SemaRef),
4706 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004707
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004708 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004709 SourceLocation Loc,
4710 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004711 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4712 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004713
4714 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
4715 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
4716
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004717 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004718 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
4719
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004720 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
4721 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
4722
4723 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
4724 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
4725
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004726 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
4727 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
4728
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004729 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004730 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004731
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004732 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
4733 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004734
4735 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
4736 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004737};
4738
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004739/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004740/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4741/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4742/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4743/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4744/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4745/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004746///
4747/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004748bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004749BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4750 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004751
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004752 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004753 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004754 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004755
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004756 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004757 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004758 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004759 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004760 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004761 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004762 buildObjCPtr = true;
4763 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004764 else
4765 assert(false && "type was not a pointer type!");
4766 }
4767 else
4768 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004769
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004770 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4771 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4772 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4773 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4774 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4775 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004776 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00004777 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00004778 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004779 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
4780 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004781
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004782 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
4783 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4784 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004785 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
4786 // in the types.
4787 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
4788 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004789 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004790 if (!buildObjCPtr)
4791 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
4792 else
4793 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004794 }
4795
4796 return true;
4797}
4798
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004799/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
4800/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4801/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4802/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4803/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4804/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4805/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004806///
4807/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004808bool
4809BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
4810 QualType Ty) {
4811 // Insert this type.
4812 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
4813 return false;
4814
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004815 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4816 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004817
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004818 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004819 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4820 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4821 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4822 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4823 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4824 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004825 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
4826
4827 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
4828 // qualifiers.
4829 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
4830 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4831 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004832
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004833 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004834 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
4835 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004836 }
4837
4838 return true;
4839}
4840
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004841/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
4842/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004843/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
4844/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004845/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
4846/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
4847/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
4848/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004849void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004850BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004851 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004852 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004853 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4854 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004855 // Only deal with canonical types.
4856 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
4857
4858 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
4859 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004860 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004861 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
4862
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004863 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
4864 if (Ty->isArrayType())
4865 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
4866
4867 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004868 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004869
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004870 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
4871 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
4872 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
4873
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004874 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
4875 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
4876 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
4877
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004878 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
4879 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
4880 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004881 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
4882 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004883 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004884 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004885 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
4886 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
4887 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
4888 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004889 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004890 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004891 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004892 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004893 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
4894 // extension.
4895 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004896 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004897 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
4898 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
4899 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
4900 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004901
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004902 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
4903 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
4904 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4905 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
4906 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
4907 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4908 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4909 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004910
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004911 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
4912 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
4913 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
4914 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004915
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004916 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4917 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
4918 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
4919 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004920 }
4921 }
4922 }
4923}
4924
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004925/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
4926/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
4927/// given type to the candidate set.
4928static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
4929 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004930 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004931 unsigned NumArgs,
4932 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4933 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004934
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004935 // T& operator=(T&, T)
4936 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
4937 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4938 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4939 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004940
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004941 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
4942 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004943 ParamTypes[0]
4944 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004945 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4946 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004947 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004948 }
4949}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004950
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004951/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
4952/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004953static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
4954 Qualifiers VRQuals;
4955 const RecordType *TyRec;
4956 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
4957 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00004958 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004959 else
4960 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
4961 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004962 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004963 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4964 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4965 return VRQuals;
4966 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004967
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004968 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00004969 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
4970 return VRQuals;
4971
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004972 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004973 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004974
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004975 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00004976 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004977 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4978 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4979 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4980 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004981 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
4982 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4983 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
4984 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
4985 // as see them.
4986 bool done = false;
4987 while (!done) {
4988 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
4989 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004990 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004991 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
4992 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
4993 else
4994 done = true;
4995 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
4996 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4997 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
4998 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4999 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
5000 return VRQuals;
5001 }
5002 }
5003 }
5004 return VRQuals;
5005}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005006
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005007namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005008
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005009/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
5010/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
5011/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
5012/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
5013class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005014 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
5015 Sema &S;
5016 Expr **Args;
5017 unsigned NumArgs;
5018 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005019 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005020 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
5021 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005022
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005023 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
5024 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005025 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
5026 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005027 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
5028 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
5029 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
5030 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
5031 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
5032 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
5033 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
5034
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005035 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
5036 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
5037 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
5038 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
5039 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
5040 // Start of promoted types.
5041 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
5042 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
5043 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005044
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005045 // Start of integral types.
5046 &ASTContext::IntTy,
5047 &ASTContext::LongTy,
5048 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
5049 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
5050 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
5051 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
5052 // End of promoted types.
5053
5054 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
5055 &ASTContext::CharTy,
5056 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
5057 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
5058 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
5059 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
5060 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
5061 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
5062 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
5063 // End of integral types.
5064 // FIXME: What about complex?
5065 };
5066 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
5067 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005068
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005069 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
5070 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
5071 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
5072 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
5073 // The rules are basically:
5074 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
5075 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
5076 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
5077 // - use the larger type
5078 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
5079 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
5080 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
5081 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
5082 // better not to make any assumptions).
5083 enum PromotedType {
5084 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1
5085 };
5086 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
5087 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
5088 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
5089 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
5090 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
5091 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
5092 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
5093 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
5094 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
5095 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
5096 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL },
5097 };
5098
5099 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5100 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5101 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
5102
5103 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005104 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005105
5106 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
5107 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005108 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
5109 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005110 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
5111 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
5112
5113 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
5114 if (LW > RW) return LT;
5115 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
5116
5117 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
5118 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
5119 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
5120 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
5121 }
5122
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00005123 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
5124 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005125 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
5126 bool HasVolatile) {
5127 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5128 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
5129 S.Context.IntTy
5130 };
5131
5132 // Non-volatile version.
5133 if (NumArgs == 1)
5134 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5135 else
5136 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5137
5138 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
5139 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
5140 if (HasVolatile) {
5141 ParamTypes[0] =
5142 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
5143 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
5144 if (NumArgs == 1)
5145 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5146 else
5147 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5148 }
5149 }
5150
5151public:
5152 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
5153 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5154 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005155 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005156 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
5157 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
5158 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
5159 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005160 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
5161 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005162 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
5163 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
5164 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005165 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005166 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005167 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
5168 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005169 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005170 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
5171 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005172 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005173 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
5174 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005175 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
5176 }
5177
5178 // C++ [over.built]p3:
5179 //
5180 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
5181 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
5182 // functions of the form
5183 //
5184 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
5185 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
5186 //
5187 // C++ [over.built]p4:
5188 //
5189 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
5190 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
5191 // candidate operator functions of the form
5192 //
5193 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
5194 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
5195 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005196 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5197 return;
5198
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005199 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
5200 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
5201 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005202 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005203 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
5204 }
5205 }
5206
5207 // C++ [over.built]p5:
5208 //
5209 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5210 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
5211 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5212 //
5213 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
5214 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
5215 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
5216 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
5217 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
5218 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5219 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5220 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5221 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5222 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005223 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005224 continue;
5225
5226 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
5227 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5228 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
5229 }
5230 }
5231
5232 // C++ [over.built]p6:
5233 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
5234 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5235 //
5236 // T& operator*(T*);
5237 //
5238 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005239 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005240 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005241 // T& operator*(T*);
5242 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
5243 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5244 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5245 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5246 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5247 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5248 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005249 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5250 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005251
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005252 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
5253 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
5254 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005255
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005256 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
5257 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5258 }
5259 }
5260
5261 // C++ [over.built]p9:
5262 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
5263 // operator functions of the form
5264 //
5265 // T operator+(T);
5266 // T operator-(T);
5267 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005268 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5269 return;
5270
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005271 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5272 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005273 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005274 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5275 }
5276
5277 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
5278 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5279 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5280 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5281 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5282 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5283 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5284 }
5285 }
5286
5287 // C++ [over.built]p8:
5288 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
5289 // the form
5290 //
5291 // T* operator+(T*);
5292 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
5293 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5294 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5295 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5296 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5297 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5298 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5299 }
5300 }
5301
5302 // C++ [over.built]p10:
5303 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
5304 // operator functions of the form
5305 //
5306 // T operator~(T);
5307 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005308 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5309 return;
5310
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005311 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5312 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005313 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005314 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5315 }
5316
5317 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
5318 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5319 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5320 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5321 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5322 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5323 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5324 }
5325 }
5326
5327 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
5328 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
5329 // functions of the form
5330 //
5331 // bool operator==(T,T);
5332 // bool operator!=(T,T);
5333 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
5334 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5335 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5336
5337 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5338 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5339 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5340 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5341 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
5342 ++MemPtr) {
5343 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5344 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5345 continue;
5346
5347 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5348 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5349 CandidateSet);
5350 }
5351 }
5352 }
5353
5354 // C++ [over.built]p15:
5355 //
5356 // For every pointer or enumeration type T, there exist
5357 // candidate operator functions of the form
5358 //
5359 // bool operator<(T, T);
5360 // bool operator>(T, T);
5361 // bool operator<=(T, T);
5362 // bool operator>=(T, T);
5363 // bool operator==(T, T);
5364 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005365 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5366 // C++ [over.built]p1:
5367 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
5368 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
5369 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
5370 // functions.
5371 //
5372 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
5373 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
5374 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
5375 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
5376 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
5377 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
5378 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
5379 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
5380 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
5381
5382 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5383 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
5384 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
5385 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
5386 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5387 C != CEnd; ++C) {
5388 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
5389 continue;
5390
5391 QualType FirstParamType =
5392 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5393 QualType SecondParamType =
5394 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5395
5396 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
5397 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
5398 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
5399 continue;
5400
5401 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
5402 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
5403 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
5404 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
5405 }
5406 }
5407 }
5408
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005409 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5410 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5411
5412 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5413 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5414 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5415 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5416 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5417 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5418 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5419 continue;
5420
5421 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5422 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5423 CandidateSet);
5424 }
5425 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5426 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5427 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5428 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5429 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
5430
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005431 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
5432 // candidate exists.
5433 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
5434 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
5435 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005436 continue;
5437
5438 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005439 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5440 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005441 }
5442 }
5443 }
5444
5445 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5446 //
5447 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
5448 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5449 //
5450 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5451 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
5452 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5453 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5454 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
5455 //
5456 // C++ [over.built]p14:
5457 //
5458 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
5459 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5460 //
5461 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5462 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
5463 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5464 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5465
5466 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
5467 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
5468 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5469 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5470 };
5471 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5472 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
5473 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
5474 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005475 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5476 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
5477 continue;
5478
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005479 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
5480 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
5481 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
5482 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5483 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
5484 CandidateSet);
5485 }
5486 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
5487 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5488 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5489 continue;
5490
5491 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5492 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
5493 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5494 }
5495 }
5496 }
5497 }
5498
5499 // C++ [over.built]p12:
5500 //
5501 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
5502 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5503 //
5504 // LR operator*(L, R);
5505 // LR operator/(L, R);
5506 // LR operator+(L, R);
5507 // LR operator-(L, R);
5508 // bool operator<(L, R);
5509 // bool operator>(L, R);
5510 // bool operator<=(L, R);
5511 // bool operator>=(L, R);
5512 // bool operator==(L, R);
5513 // bool operator!=(L, R);
5514 //
5515 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5516 // between types L and R.
5517 //
5518 // C++ [over.built]p24:
5519 //
5520 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
5521 // candidate operator functions of the form
5522 //
5523 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
5524 //
5525 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5526 // between types L and R.
5527 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
5528 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005529 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5530 return;
5531
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005532 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5533 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
5534 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5535 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005536 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5537 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005538 QualType Result =
5539 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005540 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005541 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5542 }
5543 }
5544
5545 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
5546 // conditional operator for vector types.
5547 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5548 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5549 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5550 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5551 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5552 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5553 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5554 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5555 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
5556 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
5557 if (!isComparison) {
5558 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
5559 Result = *Vec1;
5560 else
5561 Result = *Vec2;
5562 }
5563
5564 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5565 }
5566 }
5567 }
5568
5569 // C++ [over.built]p17:
5570 //
5571 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
5572 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5573 //
5574 // LR operator%(L, R);
5575 // LR operator&(L, R);
5576 // LR operator^(L, R);
5577 // LR operator|(L, R);
5578 // L operator<<(L, R);
5579 // L operator>>(L, R);
5580 //
5581 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5582 // between types L and R.
5583 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005584 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5585 return;
5586
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005587 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5588 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
5589 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5590 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005591 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5592 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005593 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
5594 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005595 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005596 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5597 }
5598 }
5599 }
5600
5601 // C++ [over.built]p20:
5602 //
5603 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
5604 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
5605 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5606 //
5607 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
5608 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5609 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5610 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5611
5612 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5613 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5614 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5615 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5616 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5617 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5618 continue;
5619
5620 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
5621 CandidateSet);
5622 }
5623
5624 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5625 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5626 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5627 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5628 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5629 continue;
5630
5631 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
5632 CandidateSet);
5633 }
5634 }
5635 }
5636
5637 // C++ [over.built]p19:
5638 //
5639 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
5640 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
5641 // of the form
5642 //
5643 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
5644 //
5645 // C++ [over.built]p21:
5646 //
5647 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5648 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
5649 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5650 //
5651 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5652 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5653 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
5654 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5655 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5656
5657 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5658 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5659 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5660 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5661 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
5662 if (isEqualOp)
5663 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005664 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
5665 continue;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005666
5667 // non-volatile version
5668 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5669 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5670 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5671 };
5672 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5673 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
5674
5675 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5676 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5677 // volatile version
5678 ParamTypes[0] =
5679 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
5680 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5681 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5682 }
5683 }
5684
5685 if (isEqualOp) {
5686 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5687 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5688 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5689 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5690 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
5691 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5692 continue;
5693
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005694 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5695 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5696 *Ptr,
5697 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005698
5699 // non-volatile version
5700 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5701 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
5702
5703 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5704 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5705 // volatile version
5706 ParamTypes[0] =
5707 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005708 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5709 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005710 }
5711 }
5712 }
5713 }
5714
5715 // C++ [over.built]p18:
5716 //
5717 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
5718 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
5719 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
5720 // the form
5721 //
5722 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
5723 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
5724 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
5725 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
5726 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
5727 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005728 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5729 return;
5730
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005731 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
5732 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5733 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
5734 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005735 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005736
5737 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5738 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005739 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005740 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5741 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5742
5743 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5744 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5745 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005746 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005747 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005748 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5749 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005750 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5751 }
5752 }
5753 }
5754
5755 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
5756 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5757 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5758 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5759 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5760 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5761 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5762 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5763 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5764 QualType ParamTypes[2];
5765 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
5766 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5767 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
5768 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5769 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5770
5771 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5772 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5773 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
5774 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005775 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5776 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005777 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5778 }
5779 }
5780 }
5781 }
5782
5783 // C++ [over.built]p22:
5784 //
5785 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
5786 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
5787 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5788 //
5789 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
5790 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
5791 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
5792 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
5793 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
5794 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
5795 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005796 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5797 return;
5798
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005799 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
5800 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5801 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
5802 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005803 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005804
5805 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5806 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005807 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005808 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5809 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5810 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005811 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005812 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
5813 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
5814 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5815 CandidateSet);
5816 }
5817 }
5818 }
5819 }
5820
5821 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
5822 //
5823 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
5824 //
5825 // bool operator!(bool);
5826 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
5827 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
5828 void addExclaimOverload() {
5829 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
5830 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
5831 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5832 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
5833 }
5834 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
5835 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
5836 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5837 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5838 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
5839 }
5840
5841 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5842 //
5843 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
5844 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5845 //
5846 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5847 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
5848 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5849 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
5850 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
5851 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
5852 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5853 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5854 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5855 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5856 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
5857 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005858 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
5859 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005860
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005861 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5862
5863 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
5864 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5865 }
5866
5867 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5868 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5869 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5870 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5871 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
5872 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005873 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
5874 continue;
5875
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005876 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5877
5878 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
5879 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5880 }
5881 }
5882
5883 // C++ [over.built]p11:
5884 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
5885 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
5886 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
5887 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5888 //
5889 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
5890 //
5891 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
5892 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
5893 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5894 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5895 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5896 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5897 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
5898 QualType C1;
5899 QualifierCollector Q1;
5900 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
5901 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
5902 continue;
5903 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
5904 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
5905 // volatile/restrict type.
5906 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
5907 continue;
5908 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
5909 continue;
5910 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5911 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
5912 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
5913 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5914 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
5915 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
5916 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
5917 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
5918 break;
5919 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
5920 // build CV12 T&
5921 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
5922 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
5923 T.isVolatileQualified())
5924 continue;
5925 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
5926 T.isRestrictQualified())
5927 continue;
5928 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
5929 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
5930 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5931 }
5932 }
5933 }
5934
5935 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
5936 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
5937 // therefore added as binary.
5938 //
5939 // C++ [over.built]p25:
5940 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
5941 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5942 //
5943 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
5944 //
5945 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
5946 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5947 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5948
5949 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5950 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5951 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5952 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5953 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5954 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5955 continue;
5956
5957 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5958 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5959 }
5960
5961 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5962 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5963 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5964 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5965 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5966 continue;
5967
5968 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5969 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5970 }
5971
5972 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
5973 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5974 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5975 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5976 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5977 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
5978 continue;
5979
5980 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5981 continue;
5982
5983 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
5984 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5985 }
5986 }
5987 }
5988 }
5989};
5990
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005991} // end anonymous namespace
5992
5993/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
5994/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
5995/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
5996/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
5997/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
5998void
5999Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6000 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6001 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6002 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006003 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
6004 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006005 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
6006 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006007 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
6008 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00006009 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
6010 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006011
6012 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
6013 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00006014 llvm::SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
6015 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6016 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
6017 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
6018 OpLoc,
6019 true,
6020 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
6021 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
6022 Op == OO_PipePipe),
6023 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006024 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
6025 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
6026 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
6027 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
6028 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00006029 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006030
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006031 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
6032 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
6033 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType)
6034 return;
6035
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006036 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
6037 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
6038 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006039 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006040 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
6041
6042 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006043 switch (Op) {
6044 case OO_None:
6045 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
6046 assert(false && "Expected an overloaded operator");
6047 break;
6048
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006049 case OO_New:
6050 case OO_Delete:
6051 case OO_Array_New:
6052 case OO_Array_Delete:
6053 case OO_Call:
6054 assert(false && "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
6055 break;
6056
6057 case OO_Comma:
6058 case OO_Arrow:
6059 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6060 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6061 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006062 break;
6063
6064 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006065 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006066 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006067 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006068
6069 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006070 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006071 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006072 } else {
6073 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
6074 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6075 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006076 break;
6077
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006078 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006079 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006080 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
6081 else
6082 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6083 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006084
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006085 case OO_Slash:
6086 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006087 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006088
6089 case OO_PlusPlus:
6090 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006091 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6092 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006093 break;
6094
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006095 case OO_EqualEqual:
6096 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006097 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006098 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006099
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006100 case OO_Less:
6101 case OO_Greater:
6102 case OO_LessEqual:
6103 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006104 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006105 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
6106 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006107
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006108 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006109 case OO_Caret:
6110 case OO_Pipe:
6111 case OO_LessLess:
6112 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006113 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006114 break;
6115
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006116 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
6117 if (NumArgs == 1)
6118 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6119 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6120 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
6121 break;
6122
6123 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6124 break;
6125
6126 case OO_Tilde:
6127 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
6128 break;
6129
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006130 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006131 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006132 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006133
6134 case OO_PlusEqual:
6135 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006136 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006137 // Fall through.
6138
6139 case OO_StarEqual:
6140 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006141 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006142 break;
6143
6144 case OO_PercentEqual:
6145 case OO_LessLessEqual:
6146 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
6147 case OO_AmpEqual:
6148 case OO_CaretEqual:
6149 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006150 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006151 break;
6152
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006153 case OO_Exclaim:
6154 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006155 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006156
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006157 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006158 case OO_PipePipe:
6159 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006160 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006161
6162 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006163 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006164 break;
6165
6166 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006167 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006168 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00006169
6170 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006171 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006172 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6173 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006174 }
6175}
6176
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006177/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
6178/// to the set of overloading candidates.
6179///
6180/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
6181/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
6182/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
6183/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006184void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006185Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006186 bool Operator,
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006187 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00006188 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006189 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00006190 bool PartialOverloading,
6191 bool StdNamespaceIsAssociated) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006192 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006193
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00006194 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
6195 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
6196 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
6197 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
6198 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
6199 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
6200
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006201 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00006202 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns,
6203 StdNamespaceIsAssociated);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006204
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006205 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006206 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
6207 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6208 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006209 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006210 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006211 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006212 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006213 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006214
6215 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
6216 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006217 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006218 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006219 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00006220 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006221 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006222
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006223 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00006224 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006225 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006226 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006227 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00006228 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006229 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006230}
6231
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006232/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
6233/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006234bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006235isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006236 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
6237 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006238 SourceLocation Loc,
6239 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006240 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
6241 // functions.
6242 if (!Cand2.Viable)
6243 return Cand1.Viable;
6244 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
6245 return false;
6246
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006247 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
6248 //
6249 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
6250 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
6251 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
6252 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
6253 unsigned StartArg = 0;
6254 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
6255 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006256
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006257 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006258 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
6259 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006260 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006261 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
6262 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
6263 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006264 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006265 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6266 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006267 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
6268 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6269 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6270 HasBetterConversion = true;
6271 break;
6272
6273 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6274 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6275 return false;
6276
6277 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6278 // Do nothing.
6279 break;
6280 }
6281 }
6282
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006283 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006284 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006285 if (HasBetterConversion)
6286 return true;
6287
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006288 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006289 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00006290 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006291 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
6292 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006293
6294 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
6295 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
6296 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006297 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00006298 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006299 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006300 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006301 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6302 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6303 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006304 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregorb837ea42011-01-11 17:34:58 +00006305 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006306 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006307 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006308 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006309
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006310 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
6311 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
6312 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
6313 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
6314 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
6315 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006316 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006317 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006318 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006319 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
6320 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006321 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
6322 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6323 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6324 return true;
6325
6326 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6327 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6328 return false;
6329
6330 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6331 // Do nothing
6332 break;
6333 }
6334 }
6335
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006336 return false;
6337}
6338
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006339/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006340/// within an overload candidate set.
6341///
6342/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
6343///
6344/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
6345/// which overload resolution occurs.
6346///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006347/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006348/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
6349///
6350/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006351OverloadingResult
6352OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006353 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00006354 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006355 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006356 Best = end();
6357 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
6358 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006359 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006360 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006361 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006362 }
6363
6364 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006365 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006366 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
6367
6368 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
6369 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006370 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006371 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006372 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006373 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006374 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006375 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006376 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006377 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006378 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006379
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006380 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006381 if (Best->Function &&
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00006382 (Best->Function->isDeleted() || Best->Function->isUnavailable()))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006383 return OR_Deleted;
6384
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006385 return OR_Success;
6386}
6387
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006388namespace {
6389
6390enum OverloadCandidateKind {
6391 oc_function,
6392 oc_method,
6393 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006394 oc_function_template,
6395 oc_method_template,
6396 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006397 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
6398 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006399 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
6400 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006401};
6402
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006403OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
6404 FunctionDecl *Fn,
6405 std::string &Description) {
6406 bool isTemplate = false;
6407
6408 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
6409 isTemplate = true;
6410 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6411 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
6412 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006413
6414 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006415 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006416 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006417
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006418 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
6419 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
6420
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006421 return Ctor->isCopyConstructor() ? oc_implicit_copy_constructor
6422 : oc_implicit_default_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006423 }
6424
6425 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
6426 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
6427 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006428 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006429 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006430
Douglas Gregorec3bec02010-09-27 22:37:28 +00006431 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006432 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006433 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
6434 }
6435
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006436 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006437}
6438
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006439void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
6440 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
6441 if (!Ctor) return;
6442
6443 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
6444 if (!Ctor) return;
6445
6446 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
6447}
6448
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006449} // end anonymous namespace
6450
6451// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
6452void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006453 std::string FnDesc;
6454 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
6455 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6456 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006457 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006458}
6459
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00006460//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
6461// OverloadedExpr
6462void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr) {
6463 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
6464
6465 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
6466 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
6467
6468 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6469 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
6470 I != IEnd; ++I) {
6471 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
6472 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6473 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
6474 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
6475 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6476 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun);
6477 }
6478 }
6479}
6480
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006481/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
6482/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
6483/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006484void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
6485 Sema &S,
6486 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
6487 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
6488 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
6489 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006490 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006491 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6492 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006493 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006494}
6495
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006496namespace {
6497
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006498void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
6499 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
6500 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006501 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
6502 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6503
6504 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
6505 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
6506 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006507 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006508 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006509 if (I == 0)
6510 isObjectArgument = true;
6511 else
6512 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006513 }
6514
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006515 std::string FnDesc;
6516 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
6517
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006518 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
6519 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
6520 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006521
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006522 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006523 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006524 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
6525 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
6526 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006527 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006528
6529 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
6530 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6531 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6532 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006533 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006534 return;
6535 }
6536
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006537 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
6538 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006539 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
6540 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
6541 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6542 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
6543 else {
6544 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
6545 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6546 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6547 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
6548 }
6549
6550 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
6551 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
6552 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
6553 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
6554 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6555 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
6556 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6557
6558 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
6559 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
6560
6561 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
6562 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
6563 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6564 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6565 << FromTy
6566 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
6567 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006568 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006569 return;
6570 }
6571
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00006572 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
6573 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
6574 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6575 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6576 << FromTy
6577 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
6578 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6579 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
6580 return;
6581 }
6582
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006583 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
6584 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
6585
6586 if (isObjectArgument) {
6587 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
6588 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6589 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6590 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
6591 } else {
6592 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
6593 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6594 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6595 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
6596 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006597 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006598 return;
6599 }
6600
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006601 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
6602 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
6603 // the failure.
6604 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
6605 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6606 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6607 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
6608 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
6609 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6610 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6611 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006612 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006613 return;
6614 }
6615
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006616 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006617 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006618 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6619 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6620 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6621 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6622 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6623 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006624 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006625 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006626 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006627 }
6628 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
6629 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
6630 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
6631 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6632 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6633 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6634 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6635 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6636 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006637 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
6638 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6639 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
6640 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
6641 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6642 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
6643 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
6644 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006645
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006646 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006647 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006648 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006649 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6650 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006651 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006652 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006653 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006654 return;
6655 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006656
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006657 // TODO: specialize more based on the kind of mismatch
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006658 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv)
6659 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006660 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
John McCalla1709fd2010-01-14 00:56:20 +00006661 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006662 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006663}
6664
6665void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6666 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
6667 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
6668
6669 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6670 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6671
6672 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006673
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006674 // at least / at most / exactly
6675 unsigned mode, modeCount;
6676 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006677 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
6678 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6679 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006680 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregor7825bf32011-01-06 22:09:01 +00006681 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006682 mode = 0; // "at least"
6683 else
6684 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6685 modeCount = MinParams;
6686 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006687 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
6688 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6689 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006690 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
6691 mode = 1; // "at most"
6692 else
6693 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6694 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
6695 }
6696
6697 std::string Description;
6698 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
6699
6700 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006701 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006702 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006703 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006704}
6705
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006706/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
6707void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6708 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
6709 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
6710
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006711 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006712 NamedDecl *ParamD;
6713 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
6714 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
6715 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006716 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
6717 case Sema::TDK_Success:
6718 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
6719
6720 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006721 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
6722 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
6723 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006724 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006725 return;
6726 }
6727
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006728 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
6729 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
6730 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
6731
6732 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
6733
6734 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
6735 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006736 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006737 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006738 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006739 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
6740
6741 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
6742 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
6743 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
6744 // done on dependent types).
6745 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
6746
6747 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
6748 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006749 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006750 return;
6751 }
6752
6753 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006754 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006755 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006756 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006757 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006758 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006759 which = 1;
6760 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006761 which = 2;
6762 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006763
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006764 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006765 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006766 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
6767 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006768 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006769 return;
6770 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006771
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006772 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006773 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006774 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006775 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006776 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
6777 << ParamD->getDeclName();
6778 else {
6779 int index = 0;
6780 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
6781 index = TTP->getIndex();
6782 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
6783 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
6784 index = NTTP->getIndex();
6785 else
6786 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006787 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006788 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
6789 << (index + 1);
6790 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006791 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006792 return;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006793
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006794 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
6795 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
6796 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
6797 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006798
6799 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
6800 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006801 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006802 return;
6803
6804 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
6805 std::string ArgString;
6806 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
6807 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
6808 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6809 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
6810 *Args);
6811 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
6812 << ArgString;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006813 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006814 return;
6815 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006816
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006817 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
6818 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006819 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006820 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
6821 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006822 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006823 return;
6824 }
6825}
6826
6827/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
6828/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
6829///
6830/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
6831/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
6832/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
6833/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
6834/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
6835/// overload.
6836///
6837/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
6838/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
6839/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006840void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6841 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006842 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6843
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006844 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00006845 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || Fn->isUnavailable())) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006846 std::string FnDesc;
6847 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006848
6849 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006850 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006851 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006852 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006853 }
6854
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006855 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
6856 if (Cand->Viable) {
6857 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
6858 return;
6859 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006860
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006861 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
6862 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
6863 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
6864 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006865
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006866 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006867 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
6868
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006869 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
6870 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006871 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006872 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006873
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006874 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
6875 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
6876 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006877 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
6878 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006879
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006880 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
6881 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
6882 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
6883 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006884 }
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006885 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006886}
6887
6888void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6889 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
6890 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
6891 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
6892 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
6893 bool isLValueReference = false;
6894 bool isRValueReference = false;
6895 bool isPointer = false;
6896 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6897 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
6898 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6899 isLValueReference = true;
6900 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6901 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
6902 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6903 isRValueReference = true;
6904 }
6905 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6906 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
6907 isPointer = true;
6908 }
6909 // Desugar down to a function type.
6910 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
6911 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
6912 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
6913 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
6914 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
6915
6916 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
6917 << FnType;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006918 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006919}
6920
6921void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
6922 const char *Opc,
6923 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6924 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6925 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
6926 std::string TypeStr("operator");
6927 TypeStr += Opc;
6928 TypeStr += "(";
6929 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
6930 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
6931 TypeStr += ")";
6932 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6933 } else {
6934 TypeStr += ", ";
6935 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
6936 TypeStr += ")";
6937 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6938 }
6939}
6940
6941void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6942 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6943 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size();
6944 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
6945 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006946 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
6947 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
6948
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006949 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006950 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006951 }
6952}
6953
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006954SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6955 if (Cand->Function)
6956 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006957 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006958 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
6959 return SourceLocation();
6960}
6961
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006962struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
6963 Sema &S;
6964 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006965
6966 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
6967 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006968 // Fast-path this check.
6969 if (L == R) return false;
6970
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006971 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006972 if (L->Viable) {
6973 if (!R->Viable) return true;
6974
6975 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
6976 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
6977 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006978 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
6979 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006980 } else if (R->Viable)
6981 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006982
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006983 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006984
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006985 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
6986 if (!L->Viable) {
6987 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
6988 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6989 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6990 return false;
6991 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6992 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6993 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006994
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006995 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
6996 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
6997 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
6998 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
6999 return true;
7000
7001 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
7002 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
7003 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
7004
7005 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00007006 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
7007 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007008 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7009 L->Conversions[I],
7010 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007011 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7012 leftBetter++;
7013 break;
7014
7015 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7016 leftBetter--;
7017 break;
7018
7019 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7020 break;
7021 }
7022 }
7023 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
7024 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
7025
7026 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
7027 return false;
7028
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007029 // TODO: others?
7030 }
7031
7032 // Sort everything else by location.
7033 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
7034 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
7035
7036 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
7037 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
7038 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
7039
7040 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007041 }
7042};
7043
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007044/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
7045/// computes up to the first
7046void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7047 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7048 assert(!Cand->Viable);
7049
7050 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
7051 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
7052
7053 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007054 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007055 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
7056 while (true) {
7057 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
7058 ConvIdx++;
7059 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad())
7060 break;
7061 }
7062
7063 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
7064 return;
7065
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007066 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
7067 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
7068
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00007069 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007070 // operation somehow.
7071 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007072
7073 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
7074 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
7075
7076 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
7077 QualType ConvType
7078 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7079 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
7080 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
7081 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7082 ArgIdx--;
7083 } else if (Cand->Function) {
7084 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7085 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
7086 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
7087 ArgIdx--;
7088 } else {
7089 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
7090 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
7091 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
7092 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007093 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
7094 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007095 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007096 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007097 return;
7098 }
7099
7100 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
7101 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
7102 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
7103 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto)
7104 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007105 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007106 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007107 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007108 else
7109 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
7110 }
7111}
7112
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007113} // end anonymous namespace
7114
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007115/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
7116/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007117/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007118void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
7119 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
7120 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7121 const char *Opc,
7122 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007123 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
7124 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
7125 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007126 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
7127 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007128 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007129 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007130 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007131 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007132 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
7133 Cands.push_back(Cand);
7134 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
7135 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007136 }
7137 }
7138
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007139 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007140 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007141
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007142 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007143
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007144 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007145 const Diagnostic::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007146 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007147 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7148 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00007149
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007150 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
7151 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
7152 // candidate list.
7153 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Diagnostic::Ovl_Best) {
7154 break;
7155 }
7156 ++CandsShown;
7157
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007158 if (Cand->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007159 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007160 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007161 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007162 else {
7163 assert(Cand->Viable &&
7164 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007165 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
7166 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
7167 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
7168 //
7169 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
7170 // different ambiguities, though.
7171 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007172 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007173 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
7174 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007175
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007176 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007177 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007178 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007179 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007180
7181 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007182 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007183}
7184
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007185// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
7186// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
7187// R (A) --> R(A)
7188// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
7189// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
7190// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
7191QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
7192 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
7193 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
7194 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
7195 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7196 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
7197 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7198 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007199 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007200 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7201 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7202 Ret =
7203 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
7204 return Ret;
7205}
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007206
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007207// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
7208// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
7209class AddressOfFunctionResolver
7210{
7211 Sema& S;
7212 Expr* SourceExpr;
7213 const QualType& TargetType;
7214 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
7215
7216 bool Complain;
7217 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
7218 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007219
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007220 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
7221 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007222
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007223 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
7224 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
7225 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007226 llvm::SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007227
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007228public:
7229 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
7230 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
7231 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
7232 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
7233 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
7234 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
7235 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
7236 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
7237 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
7238 {
7239 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
7240
7241 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
7242 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7243 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007244 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007245 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00007246
7247 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7248 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
7249 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
7250 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
7251 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
7252 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
7253
7254 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
7255 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
7256 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
7257 return;
7258 }
7259 }
7260
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007261 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
7262 }
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007263 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007264 return;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007265 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007266
7267 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
7268 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007269
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007270 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
7271 // C++ [over.over]p4:
7272 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
7273 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
7274 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
7275 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
7276 else
7277 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
7278 }
7279 }
7280 }
7281
7282private:
7283 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
7284 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
7285 }
7286
7287 // [ToType] [Return]
7288
7289 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7290 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7291 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
7292 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
7293 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
7294 }
7295
7296 // return true if any matching specializations were found
7297 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
7298 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
7299 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
7300 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
7301 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
7302 // static when converting to member pointer.
7303 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7304 return false;
7305 }
7306 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7307 return false;
7308
7309 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7310 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7311 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7312 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7313 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7314 // overloaded functions considered.
7315 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
7316 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
7317 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
7318 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
7319 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
7320 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
7321 Info)) {
7322 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7323 (void)Result;
7324 return false;
7325 }
7326
7327 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
7328 // This function template specicalization works.
7329 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
7330 assert(TargetFunctionType
7331 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
7332 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
7333 return true;
7334 }
7335
7336 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
7337 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007338 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007339 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
7340 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007341 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7342 return false;
7343 }
7344 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7345 return false;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007346
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007347 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00007348 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007349 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
7350 FunDecl->getType()) ||
7351 IsNoReturnConversion(Context, FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00007352 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007353 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
7354 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007355 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007356 return true;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007357 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007358 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007359
7360 return false;
7361 }
7362
7363 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
7364 bool Ret = false;
7365
7366 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
7367 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
7368 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7369 return false;
7370
7371 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7372 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
7373 I != E; ++I) {
7374 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
7375 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
7376
7377 // C++ [over.over]p3:
7378 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
7379 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
7380 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
7381 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
7382 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
7383 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7384 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
7385 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
7386 Ret = true;
7387 }
7388 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
7389 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
7390 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
7391 Ret = true;
7392 }
7393 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
7394 return Ret;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007395 }
7396
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007397 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007398 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
7399 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
7400 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
7401 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
7402 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
7403
7404 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
7405 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
7406 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
7407 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007408
7409 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
7410 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
7411 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007412
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007413 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007414 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
7415 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
7416 S.PDiag(),
7417 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7418 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
7419 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
7420 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
7421 Complain);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007422
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007423 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
7424 // Make it the first and only element
7425 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
7426 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
7427 Matches.resize(1);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007428 }
7429 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007430
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007431 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
7432 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
7433 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
7434 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
7435 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
7436 ++I;
7437 else {
7438 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
7439 Matches.set_size(N);
7440 }
7441 }
7442 }
7443
7444public:
7445 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
7446 assert(Matches.empty());
7447 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
7448 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
7449 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7450 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7451 }
7452
7453 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7454 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
7455 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
7456 }
7457
7458 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7459 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
7460 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
7461 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
7462 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
7463 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7464 }
7465
7466 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
7467 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
7468 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
7469 }
7470
7471 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
7472 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
7473 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7474 << OvlExpr->getName()
7475 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7476 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7477 }
7478
7479 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
7480
7481 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
7482 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7483 return Matches[0].second;
7484 }
7485
7486 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
7487 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7488 return &Matches[0].first;
7489 }
7490};
7491
7492/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
7493/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
7494/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
7495/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
7496///
7497/// @code
7498/// int f(double);
7499/// int f(int);
7500///
7501/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
7502/// @endcode
7503///
7504/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
7505/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
7506/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
7507FunctionDecl *
7508Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, QualType TargetType,
7509 bool Complain,
7510 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) {
7511
7512 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7513
7514 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, Complain);
7515 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
7516 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
7517 if ( NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
7518 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7519 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
7520 else
7521 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
7522 }
7523 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
7524 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
7525 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
7526 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
7527 assert(Fn);
7528 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
7529 MarkDeclarationReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00007530 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007531 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00007532 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007533
7534 return Fn;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007535}
7536
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007537/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007538/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
7539///
7540/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
7541/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007542/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007543/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007544FunctionDecl *
7545Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
7546 bool Complain,
7547 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007548 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7549 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
7550 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007551 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7552 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
7553 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007554
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007555 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007556 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007557 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007558
7559 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007560 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007561
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007562 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
7563 // whose type matches exactly.
7564 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007565 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
7566 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007567 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
7568 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007569 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
7570 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
7571 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007572 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +00007573 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7574 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007575
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007576 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7577 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7578 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7579 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7580 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7581 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007582 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007583 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007584 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
7585 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7586 Specialization, Info)) {
7587 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7588 (void)Result;
7589 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007590 }
7591
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007592 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
7593
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007594 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007595 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007596 if (Complain) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007597 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7598 << ovl->getName();
7599 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007600 }
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007601 return 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007602 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007603
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007604 Matched = Specialization;
7605 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007606 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007607
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007608 return Matched;
7609}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007610
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007611
7612
7613
7614// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that
7615// can be resolved because it identifies a single function
7616// template specialization
7617// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
7618ExprResult Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007619 Expr *SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, bool complain,
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007620 const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
7621 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007622 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
7623 assert(SrcExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007624
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007625 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007626
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007627 DeclAccessPair found;
7628 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
7629 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
7630 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
7631 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin()))
7632 return ExprError();
7633
7634 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
7635 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
7636 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
7637 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
7638 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
7639 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
7640 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
7641 if (complain) {
7642 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
7643 diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
7644 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
7645 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
7646 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
7647 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
7648 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
7649 // the static candidates were rejected.
7650 }
7651
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00007652 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007653 }
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00007654
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007655 // Fix the expresion to refer to 'fn'.
7656 SingleFunctionExpression =
7657 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr, found, fn));
7658
7659 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
7660 if (doFunctionPointerConverion)
7661 SingleFunctionExpression =
7662 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
7663 }
7664
7665 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
7666 if (complain) {
7667 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
7668 << ovl.Expression->getName()
7669 << DestTypeForComplaining
7670 << OpRangeForComplaining
7671 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
7672 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr);
7673 }
7674 return ExprError();
7675 }
7676
7677 return SingleFunctionExpression;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007678}
7679
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007680/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
7681static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007682 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007683 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007684 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7685 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7686 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007687 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007688 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
7689 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
7690
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007691 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007692 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && "Explicit template arguments?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007693 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00007694 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007695 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007696 }
7697
7698 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
7699 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007700 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
7701 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007702 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007703 return;
7704 }
7705
7706 assert(false && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
7707
7708 // do nothing?
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007709}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007710
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007711/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
7712/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007713void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007714 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7715 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7716 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007717
7718#ifndef NDEBUG
7719 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
7720 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007721 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007722 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
7723 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
7724 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
7725 //
7726 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
7727 //
7728 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007729 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007730 //
7731 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
7732 // template
7733 //
7734 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007735
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007736 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7737 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7738 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7739 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
7740 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
7741 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
7742 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007743 }
7744 }
7745#endif
7746
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007747 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
7748 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007749 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007750 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7751 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7752 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7753 }
7754
7755 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7756 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007757 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007758 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007759 PartialOverloading);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007760
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007761 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007762 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
7763 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007764 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007765 CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00007766 PartialOverloading,
7767 ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace());
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007768}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007769
7770/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
7771///
7772/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007773static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007774BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007775 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
7776 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7777 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007778 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007779
7780 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007781 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007782
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007783 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
7784 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
7785 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7786 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7787 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7788 }
7789
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007790 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
7791 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00007792 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007793 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007794
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007795 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
7796
7797 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
7798 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007799 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007800 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007801 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R,
7802 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007803 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
7804 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
7805 else
7806 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
7807
7808 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007809 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007810
7811 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
7812 // an expression with non-empty lookup results, which should never
7813 // end up here.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007814 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007815 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007816}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00007817
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007818/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007819/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
7820/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
7821/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
7822/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00007823/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007824/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007825ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007826Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007827 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7828 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00007829 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7830 Expr *ExecConfig) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007831#ifndef NDEBUG
7832 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7833 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
7834 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
7835
7836 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
7837 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
7838 FunctionDecl *F;
7839 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
7840 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
7841 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
7842 assert(0 && "performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007843
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007844 // We don't perform ADL in C.
7845 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00007846 } else
7847 assert(!ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace() &&
7848 "std is associated namespace but not doing ADL");
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007849#endif
7850
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007851 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00007852
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007853 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
7854 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
7855 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007856
7857 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
7858 // AddRecoveryCallCandidates diagnoses the error itself, so we just
7859 // bailout out if it fails.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007860 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007861 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007862 RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007863
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007864 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007865 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007866 case OR_Success: {
7867 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007868 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007869 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007870 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl? FDecl : Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(),
7871 ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007872 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00007873 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
7874 ExecConfig);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007875 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007876
7877 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00007878 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007879 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007880 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007881 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007882 break;
7883
7884 case OR_Ambiguous:
7885 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007886 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007887 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007888 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007889
7890 case OR_Deleted:
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00007891 {
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00007892 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
7893 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
7894 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00007895 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00007896 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00007897 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
7898 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007899 break;
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007900 }
7901
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007902 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007903 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007904}
7905
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007906static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00007907 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
7908 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
7909}
7910
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007911/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
7912/// operator.
7913///
7914/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
7915///
7916/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
7917/// operator.
7918///
7919/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
7920/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
7921/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
7922/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
7923/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
7924/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
7925///
7926/// \param input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007927ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007928Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
7929 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007930 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007931 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007932
7933 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
7934 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
7935 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007936 // TODO: provide better source location info.
7937 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007938
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007939 if (Input->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
7940 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Input);
7941 if (Result.isInvalid())
7942 return ExprError();
7943 Input = Result.take();
7944 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007945
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007946 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
7947 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007948
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007949 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
7950 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
7951 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007952 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007953 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00007954 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
7955 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007956 NumArgs = 2;
7957 }
7958
7959 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007960 if (Fns.empty())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007961 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007962 Opc,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007963 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007964 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007965 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007966
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007967 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007968 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00007969 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007970 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00007971 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
7972 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007973 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007974 &Args[0], NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007975 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007976 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007977 OpLoc));
7978 }
7979
7980 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007981 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007982
7983 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007984 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007985
7986 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
7987 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
7988
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007989 // Add candidates from ADL.
7990 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Douglas Gregor6ec89d42010-02-05 05:15:43 +00007991 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007992 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
7993 CandidateSet);
7994
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007995 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00007996 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007997
7998 // Perform overload resolution.
7999 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008000 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008001 case OR_Success: {
8002 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8003 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008004
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008005 if (FnDecl) {
8006 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8007 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008008
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008009 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8010
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008011 // Convert the arguments.
8012 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008013 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008014
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008015 ExprResult InputRes =
8016 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
8017 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8018 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008019 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008020 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008021 } else {
8022 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008023 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00008024 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008025 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00008026 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008027 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008028 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00008029 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008030 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008031 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008032 }
8033
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008034 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8035
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008036 // Determine the result type.
8037 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8038 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8039 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008040
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008041 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008042 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl);
8043 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8044 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008045
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00008046 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008047 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008048 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008049 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008050
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008051 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00008052 FnDecl))
8053 return ExprError();
8054
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008055 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008056 } else {
8057 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8058 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8059 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008060 ExprResult InputRes =
8061 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8062 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8063 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
8064 return ExprError();
8065 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008066 break;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008067 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008068 }
8069
8070 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
8071 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
8072 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
8073 break;
8074
8075 case OR_Ambiguous:
8076 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
8077 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8078 << Input->getType()
8079 << Input->getSourceRange();
8080 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
8081 Args, NumArgs,
8082 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
8083 return ExprError();
8084
8085 case OR_Deleted:
8086 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8087 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8088 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8089 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
8090 << Input->getSourceRange();
8091 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
8092 return ExprError();
8093 }
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008094
8095 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
8096 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
8097 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008098 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008099}
8100
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008101/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
8102/// operator.
8103///
8104/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
8105///
8106/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
8107/// operator.
8108///
8109/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
8110/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
8111/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
8112/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
8113/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
8114/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
8115///
8116/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
8117/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008118ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008119Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008120 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008121 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008122 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008123 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008124 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008125
8126 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
8127 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8128 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8129
8130 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8131 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008132 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008133 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008134 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008135 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008136 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008137 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008138 Context.DependentTy,
8139 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
8140 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008141
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008142 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
8143 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008144 VK_LValue,
8145 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008146 Context.DependentTy,
8147 Context.DependentTy,
8148 OpLoc));
8149 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008150
8151 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008152 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008153 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
8154 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008155 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008156 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
8157 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
8158 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008159 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008160 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008161 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008162 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008163 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008164 OpLoc));
8165 }
8166
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008167 // Always do property rvalue conversions on the RHS.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008168 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8169 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8170 if (Result.isInvalid())
8171 return ExprError();
8172 Args[1] = Result.take();
8173 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008174
8175 // The LHS is more complicated.
8176 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8177
8178 // There's a tension for assignment operators between primitive
8179 // property assignment and the overloaded operators.
8180 if (BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) {
8181 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty();
8182
8183 // Is the property "logically" settable?
8184 bool Settable = (PRE->isExplicitProperty() ||
8185 PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter());
8186
8187 // To avoid gratuitously inventing semantics, use the primitive
8188 // unless it isn't. Thoughts in case we ever really care:
8189 // - If the property isn't logically settable, we have to
8190 // load and hope.
8191 // - If the property is settable and this is simple assignment,
8192 // we really should use the primitive.
8193 // - If the property is settable, then we could try overloading
8194 // on a generic lvalue of the appropriate type; if it works
8195 // out to a builtin candidate, we would do that same operation
8196 // on the property, and otherwise just error.
8197 if (Settable)
8198 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8199 }
8200
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008201 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8202 if (Result.isInvalid())
8203 return ExprError();
8204 Args[0] = Result.take();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008205 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008206
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00008207 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
8208 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
8209 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
8210 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
8211 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
8212 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008213 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008214 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008215
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008216 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
8217 // create a built-in binary operator.
8218 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
8219 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8220
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008221 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008222 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008223
8224 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008225 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008226
8227 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8228 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8229
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008230 // Add candidates from ADL.
8231 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
8232 Args, 2,
8233 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
8234 CandidateSet);
8235
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008236 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00008237 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008238
8239 // Perform overload resolution.
8240 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008241 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00008242 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008243 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8244 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8245
8246 if (FnDecl) {
8247 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8248 // operator.
8249
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008250 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8251
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008252 // Convert the arguments.
8253 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008254 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008255 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008256
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008257 ExprResult Arg1 =
8258 PerformCopyInitialization(
8259 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8260 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8261 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008262 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008263 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008264
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008265 ExprResult Arg0 =
8266 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
8267 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8268 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008269 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008270 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008271 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008272 } else {
8273 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008274 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
8275 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8276 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8277 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008278 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008279 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008280
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008281 ExprResult Arg1 =
8282 PerformCopyInitialization(
8283 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8284 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
8285 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008286 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
8287 return ExprError();
8288 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
8289 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008290 }
8291
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008292 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8293
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008294 // Determine the result type.
8295 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8296 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8297 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008298
8299 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008300 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, OpLoc);
8301 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8302 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008303
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008304 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008305 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008306 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008307
8308 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008309 FnDecl))
8310 return ExprError();
8311
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008312 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008313 } else {
8314 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8315 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8316 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008317 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
8318 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8319 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8320 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008321 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008322 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008323
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008324 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
8325 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
8326 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
8327 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
8328 return ExprError();
8329 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008330 break;
8331 }
8332 }
8333
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008334 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
8335 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
8336 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
8337 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
8338 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008339 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008340 break;
8341
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008342 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
8343 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
8344 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008345 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008346 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008347 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008348 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
8349 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008350 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008351 } else {
8352 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
8353 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
8354 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008355 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008356 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008357 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
8358 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008359 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8360 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008361 return move(Result);
8362 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008363
8364 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008365 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008366 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008367 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008368 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008369 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
8370 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008371 return ExprError();
8372
8373 case OR_Deleted:
8374 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8375 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8376 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008377 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008378 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008379 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008380 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008381 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008382
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008383 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008384 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008385}
8386
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008387ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008388Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
8389 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008390 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
8391 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008392 DeclarationName OpName =
8393 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
8394
8395 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8396 // expression.
8397 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
8398
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008399 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008400 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
8401 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
8402 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008403 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00008404 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008405 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008406 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
8407 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
8408 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008409 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008410
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008411 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
8412 Args, 2,
8413 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008414 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008415 RLoc));
8416 }
8417
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008418 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8419 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8420 if (Result.isInvalid())
8421 return ExprError();
8422 Args[0] = Result.take();
8423 }
8424 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8425 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8426 if (Result.isInvalid())
8427 return ExprError();
8428 Args[1] = Result.take();
8429 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008430
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008431 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008432 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008433
8434 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
8435
8436 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8437 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8438
8439 // Add builtin operator candidates.
8440 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8441
8442 // Perform overload resolution.
8443 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008444 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008445 case OR_Success: {
8446 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8447 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8448
8449 if (FnDecl) {
8450 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8451 // operator.
8452
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008453 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
8454
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008455 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008456 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008457
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008458 // Convert the arguments.
8459 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008460 ExprResult Arg0 =
8461 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
8462 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8463 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008464 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008465 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008466
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008467 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008468 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008469 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008470 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008471 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008472 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008473 Owned(Args[1]));
8474 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
8475 return ExprError();
8476
8477 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
8478
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008479 // Determine the result type
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008480 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8481 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8482 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008483
8484 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008485 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, LLoc);
8486 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8487 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008488
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008489 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
8490 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008491 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008492 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008493
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008494 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008495 FnDecl))
8496 return ExprError();
8497
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008498 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008499 } else {
8500 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8501 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8502 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008503 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
8504 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8505 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8506 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008507 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008508 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
8509
8510 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
8511 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
8512 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
8513 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
8514 return ExprError();
8515 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008516
8517 break;
8518 }
8519 }
8520
8521 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008522 if (CandidateSet.empty())
8523 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
8524 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
8525 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
8526 else
8527 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
8528 << Args[0]->getType()
8529 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008530 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8531 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008532 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008533 }
8534
8535 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008536 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008537 << "[]"
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008538 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
8539 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008540 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
8541 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008542 return ExprError();
8543
8544 case OR_Deleted:
8545 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8546 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008547 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008548 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008549 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8550 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008551 return ExprError();
8552 }
8553
8554 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008555 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008556}
8557
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008558/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
8559/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
8560/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
8561/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
8562/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008563/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
8564/// member function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008565ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008566Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
8567 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008568 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008569 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
8570 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8571
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008572 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
8573 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008574 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008575
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008576 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
8577 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
8578 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
8579 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
8580
8581 QualType fnType =
8582 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8583
8584 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8585 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
8586 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
8587
8588 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
8589 // member function we're calling.
8590 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
8591
8592 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
8593 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
8594 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8595 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
8596
8597 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
8598 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
8599 difference.removeAddressSpace();
8600 if (difference) {
8601 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
8602 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
8603 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
8604 << qualsString
8605 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
8606 }
8607
8608 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
8609 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
8610 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
8611
8612 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
8613 op->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8614 call, 0))
8615 return ExprError();
8616
8617 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
8618 return ExprError();
8619
8620 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
8621 }
8622
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008623 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008624 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +00008625 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008626 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008627 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
8628 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008629 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008630 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008631 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008632 } else {
8633 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008634 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008635
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008636 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008637 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
8638 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
8639 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008640
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008641 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008642 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008643
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008644 // FIXME: avoid copy.
8645 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
8646 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8647 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
8648 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
8649 }
8650
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008651 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
8652 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
8653
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008654 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
8655 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
8656 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
8657 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
8658
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008659
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +00008660 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
8661 if (getLangOptions().Microsoft && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
8662 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, NumArgs,
8663 CandidateSet);
8664 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00008665 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
8666 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008667 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00008668 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008669
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008670 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008671 ObjectClassification,
8672 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008673 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008674 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008675 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008676 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008677 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008678 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00008679 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008680 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00008681 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008682
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008683 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
8684
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008685 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008686 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00008687 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008688 case OR_Success:
8689 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008690 MarkDeclarationReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008691 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008692 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008693 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008694 break;
8695
8696 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008697 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008698 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00008699 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008700 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008701 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008702 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008703
8704 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008705 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00008706 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008707 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008708 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008709 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008710
8711 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008712 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008713 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008714 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008715 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008716 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008717 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008718 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008719 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008720 }
8721
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008722 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008723
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008724 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
8725 // non-member call based on that function.
8726 if (Method->isStatic()) {
8727 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
8728 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
8729 }
8730
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008731 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008732 }
8733
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008734 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
8735 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
8736 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8737
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008738 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008739 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008740 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008741 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008742
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00008743 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008744 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008745 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008746 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008747
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008748 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008749 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
8750 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008751 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
8752 ExprResult ObjectArg =
8753 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
8754 FoundDecl, Method);
8755 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
8756 return ExprError();
8757 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
8758 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008759
8760 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008761 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
8762 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008763 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008764 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008765 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008766
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008767 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008768 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +00008769
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008770 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008771}
8772
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008773/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
8774/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
8775/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
8776/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008777ExprResult
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008778Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +00008779 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008780 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008781 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008782 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
8783 if (Object.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8784 Object = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Object.take());
8785 if (Object.isInvalid())
8786 return ExprError();
8787 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008788
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008789 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
8790 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008791
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008792 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
8793 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +00008794 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008795 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
8796 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
8797 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
8798 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008799 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00008800 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008801
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008802 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008803 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008804 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008805 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008806
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00008807 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
8808 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
8809 R.suppressDiagnostics();
8810
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008811 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00008812 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008813 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
8814 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00008815 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00008816 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008817
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008818 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
8819 // In addition, for each conversion function declared in T of the
8820 // form
8821 //
8822 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
8823 //
8824 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
8825 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +00008826 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
8827 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
8828 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
8829 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008830 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
8831 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
8832 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
8833 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
8834 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00008835 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +00008836 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00008837 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008838 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008839 NamedDecl *D = *I;
8840 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
8841 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8842 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008843
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008844 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
8845 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008846 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008847 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00008848
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008849 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008850
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008851 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
8852 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
8853 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8854 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8855 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008856
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008857 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008858 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008859 Object.get(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008860 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008861
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008862 // Perform overload resolution.
8863 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008864 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008865 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008866 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008867 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
8868 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008869 break;
8870
8871 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008872 if (CandidateSet.empty())
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008873 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
8874 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
8875 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008876 else
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008877 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008878 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008879 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008880 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008881 break;
8882
8883 case OR_Ambiguous:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008884 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008885 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008886 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008887 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008888 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008889
8890 case OR_Deleted:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008891 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008892 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
8893 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008894 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008895 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008896 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008897 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008898 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008899 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008900
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008901 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008902 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008903
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008904 if (Best->Function == 0) {
8905 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
8906 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008907 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008908 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
8909 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
8910
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008911 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008912 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008913
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008914 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
8915 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
8916 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008917
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +00008918 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00008919 // and then call it.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008920 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, Conv);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00008921 if (Call.isInvalid())
8922 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008923
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00008924 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008925 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008926 }
8927
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008928 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008929 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008930 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008931
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008932 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
8933 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
8934 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
8935 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008936 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
8937 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008938
8939 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8940 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
8941
8942 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
8943 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
8944 // list).
8945 Expr **MethodArgs;
8946 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
8947 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8948 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
8949 } else {
8950 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
8951 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008952 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008953 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
8954 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008955
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008956 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
8957 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
8958 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008959
8960 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
8961 // owned.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008962 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
8963 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8964 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8965
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008966 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008967 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008968 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008969 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008970 delete [] MethodArgs;
8971
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008972 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +00008973 Method))
8974 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008975
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008976 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
8977 // slots in the call for them.
8978 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00008979 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008980 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
8981 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8982
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008983 bool IsError = false;
8984
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008985 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008986 ExprResult ObjRes =
8987 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
8988 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8989 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
8990 IsError = true;
8991 else
8992 Object = move(ObjRes);
8993 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008994
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008995 // Check the argument types.
8996 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008997 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008998 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008999 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009000
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009001 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009002
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009003 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009004 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00009005 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009006 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009007 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009008
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009009 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
9010 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009011 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009012 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00009013 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
9014 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
9015 IsError = true;
9016 break;
9017 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009018
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00009019 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009020 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009021
9022 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
9023 }
9024
9025 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
9026 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
9027 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
9028 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009029 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
9030 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
9031 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009032 }
9033 }
9034
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00009035 if (IsError) return true;
9036
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009037 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00009038 return true;
9039
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +00009040 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009041}
9042
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009043/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009044/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009045/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009046ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009047Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009048 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
9049 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009050
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009051 if (Base->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
9052 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Base);
9053 if (Result.isInvalid())
9054 return ExprError();
9055 Base = Result.take();
9056 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009057
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009058 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
9059
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009060 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
9061 //
9062 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
9063 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
9064 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
9065 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009066 DeclarationName OpName =
9067 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009068 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00009069 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009070
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009071 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +00009072 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
9073 << Base->getSourceRange()))
9074 return ExprError();
9075
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00009076 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
9077 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
9078 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00009079
9080 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009081 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009082 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
9083 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009084 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009085
9086 // Perform overload resolution.
9087 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009088 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009089 case OR_Success:
9090 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
9091 break;
9092
9093 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
9094 if (CandidateSet.empty())
9095 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009096 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009097 else
9098 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009099 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009100 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009101 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009102
9103 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00009104 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
9105 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009106 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009107 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009108
9109 case OR_Deleted:
9110 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9111 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009112 << "->"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009113 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009114 << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009115 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009116 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009117 }
9118
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009119 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009120 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009121 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009122
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009123 // Convert the object parameter.
9124 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009125 ExprResult BaseResult =
9126 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
9127 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9128 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009129 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009130 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +00009131
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009132 // Build the operator call.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009133 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
9134 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9135 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009136
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009137 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
9138 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9139 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009140 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009141 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009142 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009143
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009144 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009145 Method))
9146 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman2d9c47e2011-04-04 01:18:25 +00009147
9148 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009149}
9150
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009151/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
9152/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
9153/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
9154/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00009155/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00009156Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009157 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009158 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009159 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
9160 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009161 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009162 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009163
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009164 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009165 }
9166
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009167 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009168 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
9169 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009170 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009171 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00009172 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009173 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009174 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009175 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009176
9177 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009178 ICE->getCastKind(),
9179 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00009180 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009181 }
9182
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009183 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009184 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009185 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009186 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9187 if (Method->isStatic()) {
9188 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
9189 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009190 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009191 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
9192 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
9193 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009194 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9195 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009196 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009197 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009198
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009199 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
9200 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
9201 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
9202 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
9203
9204 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
9205 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
9206 // appropriate pointer to member type.
9207 QualType ClassType
9208 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
9209 QualType MemPtrType
9210 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
9211
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009212 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
9213 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
9214 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009215 }
9216 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009217 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9218 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009219 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009220 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009221
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009222 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009223 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009224 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009225 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009226 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009227
9228 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009229 // FIXME: avoid copy.
9230 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009231 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009232 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9233 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009234 }
9235
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009236 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009237 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009238 Fn,
9239 ULE->getNameLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009240 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009241 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009242 TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009243 }
9244
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009245 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009246 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009247 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
9248 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9249 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9250 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
9251 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009252
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009253 Expr *Base;
9254
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009255 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
9256 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009257 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
9258 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
9259 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009260 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009261 Fn,
9262 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
9263 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009264 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009265 TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009266 } else {
9267 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
9268 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009269 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009270 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
9271 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
9272 /*isImplicit=*/true);
9273 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009274 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009275 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009276
John McCall4adb38c2011-04-27 00:36:17 +00009277 ExprValueKind valueKind;
9278 QualType type;
9279 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
9280 valueKind = VK_LValue;
9281 type = Fn->getType();
9282 } else {
9283 valueKind = VK_RValue;
9284 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
9285 }
9286
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009287 return MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009288 MemExpr->isArrow(),
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009289 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009290 Fn,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009291 Found,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009292 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009293 TemplateArgs,
John McCall4adb38c2011-04-27 00:36:17 +00009294 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009295 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009296
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009297 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
9298 return E;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009299}
9300
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009301ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009302 DeclAccessPair Found,
9303 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009304 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00009305}
9306
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009307} // end namespace clang